286943643798e9a8017a0d9e7476be39ac851dea
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 No adapter uses this command, so far.
2374 The following adapters have their own command to specify the serial string:
2375 cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla, jlink, kitprog, presto, st-link, vsllink, xds110.
2376 @end deffn
2377
2378 @section Interface Drivers
2379
2380 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2381 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2382 available at run time.
2383
2384 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2385 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2386 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2387 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2388
2389 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2390 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2391 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2395 Displays status of RTCK option.
2396 Optionally sets that option first.
2397 @end deffn
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2401 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2402 This has one driver-specific command:
2403
2404 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2405 Logs some status
2406 @end deffn
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2410 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2411 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2412 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2413 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2414 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2418 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2419 or v2 (USB bulk).
2420
2421 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2422 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2423 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2424 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2425 @example
2426 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2427 @end example
2428 @end deffn
2429
2430 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2431 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2432 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2433 @end deffn
2434
2435 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2436 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2437
2438 @itemize @minus
2439 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2440 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2441 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2442 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2443 @end itemize
2444 @end deffn
2445
2446 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2447 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2448 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2449 interface string or for user class interface.
2450 @end deffn
2451
2452 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2453 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2454 @end deffn
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2458 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2462 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2463 @end deffn
2464
2465 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2466 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2467 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2468
2469 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2470 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2471
2472 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2473 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2474
2475 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2476 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2477 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2478 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2479 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2480 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2481
2482 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2483 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2484 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2485 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2486 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2487
2488 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2489 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2490 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2491 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2492
2493 @itemize @minus
2494 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2495 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2496 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2497 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2498 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2499 switching data and direction as necessary
2500 @end itemize
2501
2502 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2503 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2506 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2507 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2508 @example
2509 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2510 @end example
2511 @end deffn
2512
2513 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2514 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2515 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2516 during device selection.
2517 @end deffn
2518
2519 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi serial} serial-number
2520 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2521 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2522 is connected to the host.
2523 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2524 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2525 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2529 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2530 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2534 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2535 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2536 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2537 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2538 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2539 and initially asserted reset signals.
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2543 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2544 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2545 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2546 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2547 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2548 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2549 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2550 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2551 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2552 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2553
2554 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2555 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2556 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2557 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2558 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2559 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2560
2561 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2562 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2563 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2564 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2565 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2566 are always driven by the FTDI.
2567
2568 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2569 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2570 @var{name}.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2574 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2575 @itemize @minus
2576 @item @option{0}, drive low
2577 @item @option{1}, drive high
2578 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2579 @end itemize
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2583 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2587 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2588
2589 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2590 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2591 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2592 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2593 @itemize @minus
2594 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2595 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2596 @end itemize
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2600 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2601
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2605 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2606 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2607 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2608
2609 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2610 @itemize @minus
2611 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2612 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2613 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2614 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2615 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2616 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2617 @end itemize
2618
2619 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2620 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2621 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2622 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2623 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2624 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2625 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2626 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2627
2628 FT232R
2629 @itemize @minus
2630 @item bit 7 - RI
2631 @item bit 6 - DCD
2632 @item bit 5 - DSR
2633 @item bit 4 - DTR
2634 @item bit 3 - CTS
2635 @item bit 2 - RTS
2636 @item bit 1 - RXD
2637 @item bit 0 - TXD
2638 @end itemize
2639
2640 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2641 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2644 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2645 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r serial_desc} @var{serial}
2649 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2650 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2651 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2655 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2656 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2660 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2664 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2668 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2672 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2676 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2677 @end deffn
2678
2679 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2680 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2681 @end deffn
2682
2683 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2684 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2685 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2686 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2687 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2688 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2689 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2690 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2691 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2692 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2693 @end deffn
2694
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2698 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2699 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2700 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2701
2702 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2703 processors which are being simulated.
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2706 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2707 sockets instead of TCP.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2711 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2712 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2716 something like:
2717
2718 @example
2719 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2720 remote_bitbang port 3335
2721 remote_bitbang host foobar
2722 @end example
2723
2724 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2725 named mysocket:
2726
2727 @example
2728 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2729 remote_bitbang port 0
2730 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733
2734 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2735 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2736 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2737 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2738
2739 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2740 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2741 default values are used.
2742 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2743 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2744 @example
2745 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2746 @end example
2747 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2748 @example
2749 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2750 @end example
2751 @end deffn
2752
2753 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2754 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2755 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2756 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2757 target board.
2758
2759 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2760 @example
2761 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2762 reset_config srst_only
2763 @end example
2764 @end deffn
2765
2766 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2767 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2768 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2769 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2770 @end deffn
2771
2772 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2773 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2774 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2775 @end deffn
2776
2777 @end deffn
2778
2779 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2780 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2781 This has one driver-specific command:
2782
2783 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2784 Display either the address of the I/O port
2785 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2786 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2787 This is a write-once setting.
2788 @end deffn
2789 @end deffn
2790
2791 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2792 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2793 transports.
2794
2795 @quotation Compatibility Note
2796 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2797 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2798 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2799 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2800 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2801 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2802 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2803 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2804 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2805 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2806 @end quotation
2807
2808 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2809 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2810 states.
2811 @end deffn
2812 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2813 Display free device internal memory.
2814 @end deffn
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2816 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2817 command version.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2820 Display the device configuration.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2823 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2824 power state.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2827 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2828 @end deffn
2829 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2830 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2831 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2832 IP configuration.
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2835 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2836 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2837 @end deffn
2838 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2839 Reset the current configuration.
2840 @end deffn
2841 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2842 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2843 @end deffn
2844 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2845 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2846 pairs.
2847
2848 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2849 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2850 @example
2851 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2852 @end example
2853 @end deffn
2854 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2855 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2856 pairs.
2857
2858 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2859 @example
2860 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2861 77a90000
2862 @end example
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2865 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2866 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2867 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2868 the serial number instead, if possible.
2869
2870 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2871 @end deffn
2872 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2873 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2874 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2875
2876 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2877 @end deffn
2878 @end deffn
2879
2880 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2881 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2882 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2883 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2884 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2885 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2886 configuration script.
2887
2888 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2889 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2890 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2891 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2892 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2893
2894 Known limitations:
2895 @itemize @bullet
2896 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2897 and 2.7 MHz.
2898 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2899 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2900 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2901 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2902 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2903 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2904 communications with the target.
2905 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2906 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2907 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2908 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2909 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2910 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2911 @end itemize
2912
2913 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2914 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2915 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2916 @end deffn
2917
2918 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2919 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2920 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2921 @end deffn
2922
2923 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2924 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2925 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2926 target as a side-effect.
2927 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2928 @end deffn
2929
2930 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2931 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2932 version, and target voltage.
2933 @end deffn
2934 @end deffn
2935
2936 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2937 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2938 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2939 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2940 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2941
2942 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2943 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2944 This is a write-once setting.
2945 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2946
2947 @itemize @minus
2948 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2949 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2950 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2951 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2952 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2953 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2954 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2955 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2956 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2957 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2958 some versions of
2959 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2960 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2961 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2962 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2963 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2964 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2965 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2966 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2967 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2968 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2969 @end itemize
2970 @end deffn
2971
2972 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2973 Display either the address of the I/O port
2974 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2975 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2976 This is a write-once setting.
2977
2978 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2979 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2980 you may encounter a problem.
2981 @end deffn
2982
2983 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2984 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2985 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2986 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2987 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2988 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2989
2990 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2991 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2992 @quotation Tip
2993 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2994 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2995 @example
2996 > parport toggling_time 1000
2997 > adapter speed 500
2998 @end example
2999 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3000 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3001 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3002 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3003 large set of samples.
3004 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3005 @example
3006 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3007 @end example
3008 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3009 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3010
3011 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3012 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3013 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3014 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3015 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3016 be conservative.
3017 @end quotation
3018 @end deffn
3019
3020 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3021 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3022 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3023 @end deffn
3024
3025 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3026 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3027
3028 @example
3029 adapter driver parport
3030 parport port 0x278
3031 parport cable wiggler
3032 @end example
3033 @end deffn
3034
3035 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3036 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3037 @deffn {Config Command} {presto serial} serial_string
3038 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3039 @end deffn
3040 @end deffn
3041
3042 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3043 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3044 @end deffn
3045
3046 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3047 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3048 @end deffn
3049
3050 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3051 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3052
3053 @quotation Note
3054 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3055 which are not currently documented here.
3056 @end quotation
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @anchor{hla_interface}
3060 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3061 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3062 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3063 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3064
3065 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3066 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3067 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3068 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3069 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3070 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3071
3072 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3073 Currently Not Supported.
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3077 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3078 @end deffn
3079
3080 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3081 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3085 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3089 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3090 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3091
3092 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3093 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3094 ST-LINK server software module}.
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3098 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3099 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3100 @end deffn
3101 @end deffn
3102
3103 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3104 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3105 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3106 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3107 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3108
3109 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3110 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3111 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3112 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3113
3114 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3115 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3116
3117 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3118 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3119 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3120
3121 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3122 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3123 ST-LINK server software module}.
3124
3125 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3126 @end deffn
3127
3128 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3129 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3130 @end deffn
3131
3132 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3133 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3134 @end deffn
3135
3136 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3137 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3138 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3139
3140 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3141 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3142 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3143 the target's supply voltage.
3144 @example
3145 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3146 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3147 @end example
3148 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3149 @example
3150 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3151 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3152 3.24891518738
3153 @end example
3154 @end deffn
3155 @end deffn
3156
3157 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3158 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3159 @end deffn
3160
3161 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3162 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3163 @end deffn
3164
3165 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3166 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3167 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3168 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3169 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3170
3171 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3172 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3173 XDS110 found will be used.
3174 @end deffn
3175
3176 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3177 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3178 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3179 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3183 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3184 version).
3185 @end deffn
3186 @end deffn
3187
3188 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3189 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3190 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3191 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3192 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3193
3194 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3195
3196 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3197 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3198
3199 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3200 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3201
3202 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3203
3204 @end deffn
3205 @end deffn
3206
3207 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3208 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3209 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3210
3211 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3212 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3213 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3214 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3215 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3216 configuration on exit.
3217
3218 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3219
3220 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3221 pinout.
3222
3223 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3224 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3225 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3226 individually.
3227 @end deffn
3228
3229 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3230 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3231 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3232 @end deffn
3233
3234 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3235 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3236 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3237 @end deffn
3238
3239 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3240 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3241 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3242 @end deffn
3243
3244 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3245 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3246 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3247 @end deffn
3248
3249 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3250 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3251 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3252 @end deffn
3253
3254 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3255 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3256 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3260 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3261 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3262 @end deffn
3263
3264 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3265 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3266 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3267 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3268 @end deffn
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3271 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3275 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3276 @end deffn
3277
3278 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3279 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3280 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3281 @end deffn
3282
3283 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3284 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3285 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3286 list can be found in the
3287 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3288 @end deffn
3289
3290 @end deffn
3291
3292 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3293 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3294 of the one which is most popular.
3295
3296 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3297
3298 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3299 pinout.
3300
3301 @end deffn
3302
3303
3304 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3305 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3306 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3307
3308 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3309 @end deffn
3310
3311
3312 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3313 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3314 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3315
3316 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319
3320 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3321 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3322 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3323
3324 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3325 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3326 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3327
3328 @itemize @minus
3329 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3330 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3331 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3332 @end itemize
3333 @end deffn
3334
3335 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3336 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3337 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3338 @end deffn
3339 @end deffn
3340
3341
3342 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3343 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3344 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3345 DPI server interface.
3346
3347 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3348 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3349 @end deffn
3350
3351 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3352 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3353 @end deffn
3354 @end deffn
3355
3356
3357 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3358
3359 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3360 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3361
3362 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3363 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3364
3365 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3366 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3367 @example
3368 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3369 @end example
3370 @end deffn
3371
3372 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3373 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3374 @example
3375 buspirate speed normal
3376 @end example
3377 @end deffn
3378
3379 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3380 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3381 @itemize @minus
3382 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3383 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3384 @end itemize
3385 For example:
3386 @example
3387 buspirate mode normal
3388 @end example
3389 @end deffn
3390
3391 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3392 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3393 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3394 For example:
3395 @example
3396 buspirate pullup 0
3397 @end example
3398 @end deffn
3399
3400 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3401 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3402 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3403 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3404 @example
3405 buspirate vreg 0
3406 @end example
3407 @end deffn
3408
3409 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3410 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3411 @end deffn
3412 @example
3413 buspirate led 1
3414 @end example
3415
3416 @end deffn
3417
3418
3419 @section Transport Configuration
3420 @cindex Transport
3421 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3422 and the debug adapter you are using,
3423 several transports may be available to
3424 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3425 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3426 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3427 version of OpenOCD.
3428 @end deffn
3429
3430 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3431 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3432
3433 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3434 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3435 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3436 adapter's driver).
3437
3438 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3439 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3440 supported by the debug adapter.
3441
3442 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3443 transport, if any.
3444 @end deffn
3445
3446 @subsection JTAG Transport
3447 @cindex JTAG
3448 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3449 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3450 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3451 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3452 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3453 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3454
3455 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3456 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3457 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3458 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3459 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3460
3461 @subsection SWD Transport
3462 @cindex SWD
3463 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3464 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3465 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3466 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3467 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3468 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3469 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3470
3471 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3472 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3473 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3474 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3475 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3476
3477 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3478 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3479 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3480 expected to change.
3481 @end deffn
3482
3483 @subsection SPI Transport
3484 @cindex SPI
3485 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3486 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3487 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3488 solution for flash programming.
3489
3490 @anchor{swimtransport}
3491 @subsection SWIM Transport
3492 @cindex SWIM
3493 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3494 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3495 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3496 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3497
3498 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3499
3500 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3501
3502 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3503 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3504 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3505 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3506 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3507
3508 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3509 @section JTAG Speed
3510 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3511 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3512 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3513 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3514 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3515 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3516 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3517 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3518 power management software that may be active.
3519
3520 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3521 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3522 target event handler.
3523 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3524 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3525 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3526 sets up those clocks).
3527 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3528 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3529 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3530 in the target config file.
3531 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3532 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3533 config file instead.
3534 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3535 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3536 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3537
3538 @example
3539 jtag_rclk 3000
3540 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3541 @end example
3542
3543 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3544 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3545 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3546 may not be the fastest solution.
3547
3548 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3549 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3550 which support adaptive clocking.
3551
3552 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3553 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3554 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3555 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3556 than the speed specified.
3557
3558 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3559 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3560 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3561 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3562
3563 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3564 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3565 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3566 JTAG clocking after setup.
3567 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3568 If the interface device can not
3569 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3570 @end deffn
3571
3572 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3573 @cindex adaptive clocking
3574 @cindex RTCK
3575 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3576 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3577 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3578 @example
3579 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3580 jtag_rclk 3000
3581 @end example
3582 @end defun
3583
3584 @node Reset Configuration
3585 @chapter Reset Configuration
3586 @cindex Reset Configuration
3587
3588 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3589 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3590 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3591 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3592 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3593 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3594 Please see the various board files for examples.
3595
3596 @quotation Note
3597 To maintainers and integrators:
3598 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3599 Normally the board configuration file
3600 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3601 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3602
3603 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3604 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3605 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3606 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3607 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3608 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3609 @end quotation
3610
3611 @section Types of Reset
3612
3613 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3614 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3615 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3616
3617 @itemize @bullet
3618 @item
3619 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3620 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3621 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3622 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3623 @item
3624 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3625 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3626 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3627 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3628 @item
3629 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3630 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3631 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3632 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3633 @item
3634 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3635 several other types of reset.
3636 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3637 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3638 There may be individual module resets.
3639 @end itemize
3640
3641 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3642 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3643 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3644 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3645 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3646 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3647 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3648 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3649 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3650
3651 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3652 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3653
3654 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3655 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3656 common issues are:
3657
3658 @itemize @bullet
3659
3660 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3661 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3662 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3663 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3664 when either of those signals is not connected.
3665 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3666 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3667 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3668 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3669
3670 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3671 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3672 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3673 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3674
3675 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3676 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3677 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3678 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3679 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3680 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3681 hardware debouncing.
3682 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3683 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3684
3685 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3686 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3687 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3688 to use push/pull output drivers.
3689 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3690 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3691 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3692 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3693
3694 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3695 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3696 issues (not limited to errata).
3697 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3698 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3699 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3700 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3701 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3702 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3703 @end itemize
3704
3705 There can also be other issues.
3706 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3707 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3708 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3709 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3710 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3711 Agreement (NDA).
3712
3713 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3714 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3715 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3716
3717 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3718 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3719
3720 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3721
3722 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3723 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3724 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3725 allowing it to be deasserted.
3726 @end deffn
3727
3728 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3729 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3730 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3731 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3732 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3733 @end deffn
3734
3735 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3736 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3737 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3738 allowing it to be deasserted.
3739 @end deffn
3740
3741 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3742 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3743 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3744 @end deffn
3745
3746 @anchor{reset_config}
3747 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3748 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3749 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3750 configuration scripts.
3751
3752 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3753 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3754 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3755 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3756 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3757 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3758 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3759 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3760
3761 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3762 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3763 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3764 -- may be specified at a time.
3765 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3766 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3767 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3768 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3769 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3770
3771 @itemize
3772 @item
3773 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3774 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3775 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3776 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3777 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3778
3779 @quotation Tip
3780 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3781 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3782 @end quotation
3783
3784 @item
3785 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3786 signal implementations.
3787 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3788 indicating everything behaves normally.
3789 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3790 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3791 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3792 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3793 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3794 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3795 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3796
3797 @item
3798 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3799 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3800 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3801 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3802 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3803 while SRST is asserted.
3804 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3805 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3806
3807 @item
3808 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3809 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3810 is required to use this option.
3811 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3812 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3813 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3814 be asserted before any target connection.
3815 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3816 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3817 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3818 @end itemize
3819
3820 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3821 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3822 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3823 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3824 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3825
3826 @itemize
3827 @item
3828 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3829 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3830 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3831 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3832
3833 @item
3834 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3835 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3836 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3837 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3838 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3839 @end itemize
3840 @end deffn
3841
3842 @section Custom Reset Handling
3843 @cindex events
3844
3845 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3846 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3847 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3848 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3849 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3850 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3851
3852 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3853 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3854 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3855 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3856 want to reset everything at once.
3857
3858 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3859 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3860 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3861 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3862 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3863 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3864 needs special attention.
3865
3866 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3867 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3868 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3869 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3870 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3871 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3872 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3873 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3874 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3875
3876 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3877 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3878 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3879 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3880 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3881
3882 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3883 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3884 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3885 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3886 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3887 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3888 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3889 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3890 or potentially some other value.
3891
3892 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3893 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3894 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3895 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3896 (or their associated targets)
3897 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3898
3899 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3900 they return.
3901 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3902 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3903 @end deffn
3904
3905 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3906 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3907 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3908 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3909 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3910 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3911 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3912 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3913 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3914 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3915 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3916 @end deffn
3917
3918 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3919 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3920 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3921 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3922 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3923 @end deffn
3924
3925
3926 @node TAP Declaration
3927 @chapter TAP Declaration
3928 @cindex TAP declaration
3929 @cindex TAP configuration
3930
3931 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3932 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3933
3934 @itemize @bullet
3935 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3936 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3937 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3938 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3939 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3940 start running that code.
3941 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3942 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3943 and missing connections.
3944 @end itemize
3945
3946 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3947 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3948 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3949 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3950 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3951
3952 @section Scan Chains
3953 @cindex scan chain
3954
3955 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3956 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3957 They also need to be added to
3958 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3959 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3960 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3961 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3962 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3963 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3964 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3965 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3966
3967 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3968 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3969 command, presented in the next chapter.
3970 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3971 debugging targets.)
3972 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3973
3974 @verbatim
3975 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3976 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3977 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3978 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3979 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3980 @end verbatim
3981
3982 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3983 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3984 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3985 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3986 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3987 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3988 until they are told to do so.
3989
3990 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3991 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3992 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3993 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3994
3995 @example
3996 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3997 @end example
3998
3999 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4000 by a given chip.
4001 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4002 and so forth.
4003 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4004 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4005 both inside a single chip and between them.
4006 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4007
4008 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4009 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4010 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4011 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4012 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4013 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4014 includes commands something like this:
4015
4016 @example
4017 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4018 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4019 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4020 @end example
4021
4022 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4023 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4024 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4025
4026 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4027 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4028 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4029 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4030 @example
4031 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4032 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4033 @}
4034 @end example
4035 @end deffn
4036
4037 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4038 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4039 and their status.
4040 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4041 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4042 but systems with a JTAG router can
4043 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4044 @end deffn
4045
4046 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4047 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4048
4049 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4050 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4051
4052 @section TAP Names
4053 @cindex dotted name
4054
4055 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4056 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4057 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4058 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4059 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4060 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4061 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4062 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4063
4064 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4065 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4066 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4067
4068 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4069
4070 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4071 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4072 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4073
4074 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4075 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4076 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4077 overridable.
4078
4079 @cindex TAP naming convention
4080 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4081 and should follow this convention:
4082
4083 @itemize @bullet
4084 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4085 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4086 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4087 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4088 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4089 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4090 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4091 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4092 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4093 with a single TAP;
4094 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4095 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4096 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4097 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4098 @end itemize
4099
4100 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4101
4102 @itemize @bullet
4103 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4104 @*The length in bits of the
4105 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4106 @end itemize
4107
4108 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4109
4110 @itemize @bullet
4111 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4112 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4113 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4114 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4115 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4116 (the TAP is linked in).
4117 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4118 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4119 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4120 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4121 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4122 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4123 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4124 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4125 values that were found but not included in the list.
4126
4127 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4128 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4129 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4130 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4131 hardware to find these values.
4132 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4133 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4134 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4135 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4136 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4137 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4138 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4139 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4140 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4141 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4142 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4143 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4144 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4145 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4146 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4147 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4148 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4149 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4150 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4151 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4152 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4153 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4154 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4155 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4156 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4157 @end itemize
4158 @end deffn
4159
4160 @section Other TAP commands
4161
4162 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4163 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4164 @end deffn
4165
4166 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4167 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4168 At this writing this TAP attribute
4169 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4170 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4171 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4172 See the next section for information about the available events.
4173
4174 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4175 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4176 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4177 @end deffn
4178
4179 @section TAP Events
4180 @cindex events
4181 @cindex TAP events
4182
4183 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4184 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4185 The other applies to debugger targets,
4186 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4187
4188 The TAP events currently defined are:
4189
4190 @itemize @bullet
4191 @item @b{post-reset}
4192 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4193 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4194 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4195 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4196 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4197
4198 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4199 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4200 of any particular target.
4201 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4202 @item @b{setup}
4203 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4204 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4205 @item @b{tap-disable}
4206 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4207 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4208 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4209 @item @b{tap-enable}
4210 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4211 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4212 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4213 @end itemize
4214
4215 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4216 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4217 contents to be accurate), you might:
4218
4219 @example
4220 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4221 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4222 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4223 @}
4224 @end example
4225
4226
4227 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4228 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4229 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4230 @cindex jrc
4231
4232 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4233 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4234 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4235 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4236 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4237
4238 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4239 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4240 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4241 be visible.
4242 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4243 ignores, such as:
4244
4245 @itemize
4246 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4247 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4248 TAPs receive new instructions.
4249 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4250 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4251 @end itemize
4252
4253 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4254 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4255 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4256 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4257
4258 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4259 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4260
4261 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4262 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4263 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4264 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4265 should define TAP event handlers using
4266 code that looks something like this:
4267
4268 @example
4269 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4270 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4271 @}
4272 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4273 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4274 @}
4275 @end example
4276
4277 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4278
4279 @example
4280 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4281 @end example
4282
4283 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4284 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4285 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4286 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4287
4288 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4289 If necessary, disables the tap
4290 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4291 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4292 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4293 and "0" if it is disabled.
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4297 If necessary, enables the tap
4298 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4299 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4300 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4301 and "0" if it is disabled.
4302 @end deffn
4303
4304 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4305 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4306 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4307 and "0" if it is disabled.
4308
4309 @quotation Note
4310 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4311 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4312 @end quotation
4313 @end deffn
4314
4315 @anchor{autoprobing}
4316 @section Autoprobing
4317 @cindex autoprobe
4318 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4319
4320 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4321 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4322 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4323 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4324
4325 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4326 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4327 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4328 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4329 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4330 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4331 right when they come out of reset).
4332
4333 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4334
4335 @example
4336 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4337 reset_config trst_and_srst
4338 jtag_rclk 8
4339 @end example
4340
4341 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4342 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4343
4344 @enumerate
4345 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4346 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4347 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4348 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4349 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4350 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4351 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4352 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4353 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4354 that is discovered.
4355 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4356 register, it will report it.
4357 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4358 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4359 @end enumerate
4360
4361 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4362 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4363 that's a bit more complex:
4364
4365 @example
4366 clock speed 8 kHz
4367 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4368 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4369 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4370 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4371 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4372 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4373 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4374 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4375 @end example
4376
4377 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4378 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4379 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4380 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4381 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4382 and so forth.
4383
4384 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4385 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4386 @cindex DAP declaration
4387
4388 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4389 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4390 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4391 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4392 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4393
4394 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4395
4396 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4397 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4398 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4399 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4400 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4401
4402 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4403
4404 @itemize @bullet
4405 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4406 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4407 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4408 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4409 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4410
4411 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4412 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4413 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4414 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4415 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4416 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4417
4418 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4419 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4420 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4421 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4422 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4423 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4424 @end itemize
4425 @end deffn
4426
4427 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4428 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4429 for TCL scripting.
4430 @end deffn
4431
4432 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4433 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4434 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4435 @end deffn
4436
4437 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4438 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4439 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4440 initialization, too.
4441 @end deffn
4442
4443 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4444
4445 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4446 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4447 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4448 @end deffn
4449
4450 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4451 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4452 @end deffn
4453
4454 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4455 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4456 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4457 or set a new value @var{value}.
4458 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4459 @end deffn
4460
4461 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4462 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4463 @end deffn
4464
4465 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4466 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4467 value @var{value}.
4468
4469 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4470 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4471 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4472
4473 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4474 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4475 @end deffn
4476
4477 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4478 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4479 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4480 @end deffn
4481
4482 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4483 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4484 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4485 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4486 @end deffn
4487
4488 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4489 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4490
4491 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4492 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4493 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4494 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4495 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4496 for details.
4497
4498 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4499 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4500 the pattern:
4501 @example
4502 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4503 @end example
4504
4505 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4506 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4507 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4508 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4509 @example
4510 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4511 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4512 @end example
4513
4514 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4515 @example
4516 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4517 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4518 @end example
4519
4520 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4521 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4522
4523 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4524 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4525 example with a proper dap name:
4526 @example
4527 xxx.dap apcsw default
4528 @end example
4529 @end deffn
4530
4531 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4532 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4533 Disabled by default
4534 @end deffn
4535
4536
4537 @node CPU Configuration
4538 @chapter CPU Configuration
4539 @cindex GDB target
4540
4541 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4542 You can also access these targets without GDB
4543 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4544 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4545 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4546 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4547
4548 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4549 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4550
4551 @section Target List
4552 @cindex target, current
4553 @cindex target, list
4554
4555 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4556 where each member has a name.
4557 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4558 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4559 (plural!) command.
4560 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4561 look like with more than one:
4562 @verbatim
4563 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4564 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4565 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4566 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4567 @end verbatim
4568
4569 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4570 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4571 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4572 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4573 space seen by that current target.
4574 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4575 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4576 are examples; and there are many more.
4577
4578 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4579
4580 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4581 Returns the name of the current target.
4582 @end deffn
4583
4584 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4585 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4586 @example
4587 foreach t [target names] @{
4588 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4589 @}
4590 @end example
4591 @end deffn
4592
4593 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4594 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4595
4596 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4597 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4598 command names are singular.}
4599
4600 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4601 targets in a user friendly form.
4602
4603 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4604 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4605 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4606 @end deffn
4607
4608 @section Target CPU Types
4609 @cindex target type
4610 @cindex CPU type
4611
4612 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4613 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4614 when calling @command{target create}.
4615 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4616 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4617 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4618 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4619 what core-specific commands may be available
4620 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4621 and more.
4622
4623 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4624 since there's a command to list them.
4625
4626 @anchor{targettypes}
4627 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4628 Lists all supported target types.
4629 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4630
4631 @itemize @bullet
4632 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4633 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4634 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4635 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4636 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4637 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4638 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4639 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4640 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4641 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4642 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4643 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4644 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4645 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4646 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4647 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4648 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4649 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4650 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4651 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4652 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4653 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4654 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4655 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4656 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4657 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4658 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4659 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4660 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4661 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4662 support for new CPUs.
4663 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4664 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4665 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4666 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4667 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4668 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4669 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4670 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4671 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4672 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4673 @itemize @minus
4674 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4675 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4676 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4677 @end itemize
4678 And two debug interfaces cores:
4679 @itemize @minus
4680 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4681 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4682 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4683 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4684 @end itemize
4685 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4686 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4687 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4688 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4689 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4690 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4691 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4692 @end itemize
4693 @end deffn
4694
4695 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4696 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4697 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4698 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4699 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4700 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4701 reflect design generations;
4702 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4703 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4704
4705 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4706 @section Target Configuration
4707
4708 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4709 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4710 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4711 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4712 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4713
4714 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4715 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4716 optional parts.
4717 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4718 command, created as part of target creation.
4719
4720 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4721 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4722 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4723 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4724 to be much more board-specific.
4725 The key steps you use might look something like this
4726
4727 @example
4728 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4729 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4730 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4731 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4732 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4733 @end example
4734
4735 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4736 on-chip SRAM.
4737 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4738 writes to target memory;
4739 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4740 GDB memory checksumming;
4741 and more.
4742
4743 @quotation Warning
4744 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4745 inaccessible when application code
4746 (such as an operating system)
4747 enables or disables the MMU.
4748 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4749 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4750 easy access to other addresses needed.
4751 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4752 @end quotation
4753
4754 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4755 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4756 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4757 controllers.
4758 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4759 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4760 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4761
4762 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4763 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4764 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4765 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4766 purposes including additional configuration.
4767
4768 @itemize @bullet
4769 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4770 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4771 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4772 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4773
4774 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4775 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4776 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4777 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4778 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4779 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4780 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4781
4782 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4783 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4784 @end itemize
4785 @end deffn
4786
4787 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4788 The options accepted by this command may also be
4789 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4790 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4791 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4792
4793 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4794 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4795 and changing its endianness.
4796
4797 @itemize @bullet
4798
4799 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4800 used to access this target.
4801
4802 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4803 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4804 create and manage DAP instances.
4805
4806 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4807 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4808
4809 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4810 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4811 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4812 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4813 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4814 same event name assigns only one handler.
4815
4816 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4817 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4818
4819 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4820 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4821 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4822 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4823 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4824 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4825 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4826
4827 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4828 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4829 or virtual address is being used.
4830
4831 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4832 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4833
4834 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4835 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4836 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4837 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4838 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4839
4840 @anchor{rtostype}
4841 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4842 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4843 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4844 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4845 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4846 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4847
4848 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4849 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4850 access the target for debugging.
4851
4852 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4853 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4854 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4855 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4856
4857 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4858 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4859 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4860 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4861 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4862
4863 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4864 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4865 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4866 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4867 command @command{gdb_port}.
4868 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4869
4870 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4871 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4872 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4873 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4874 @end itemize
4875 @end deffn
4876
4877 @section Other $target_name Commands
4878 @cindex object command
4879
4880 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4881 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4882
4883 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4884 Once a button is created a button
4885 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4886 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4887 configure it like this:
4888
4889 @example
4890 # Create
4891 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4892 # Modify
4893 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4894 # Query
4895 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4896 # Report
4897 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4898 @end example
4899
4900 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4901 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4902
4903 @example
4904 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4905 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4906 @end example
4907
4908 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4909
4910 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4911 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4912 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4913 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4914 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4915 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4916 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4917 They are not otherwise documented here.
4918 @end deffn
4919
4920 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4921 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4922 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4923 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4924 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4925 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4926 the target side uses raw memory.
4927
4928 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4929 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4930 The script orientation comes from working with data
4931 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4932 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4933 and neither store nor return those values.
4934
4935 @itemize
4936 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4937 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4938 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4939 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4940 @end itemize
4941 @end deffn
4942
4943 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4944 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4945 @command{$target_name configure}
4946 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4947 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4948 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4949 There are a few special cases:
4950
4951 @itemize @bullet
4952 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4953 event named @var{event_name}.
4954 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4955 two parameters.
4956 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4957 This is a special case because this is set using
4958 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4959 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4960 @end itemize
4961
4962 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4963 all the targets you might use something like this:
4964
4965 @example
4966 foreach name [target names] @{
4967 set y [$name cget -endian]
4968 set z [$name cget -type]
4969 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4970 $x $name $y $z]
4971 @}
4972 @end example
4973 @end deffn
4974
4975 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4976 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4977 Displays the current target state:
4978 @code{debug-running},
4979 @code{halted},
4980 @code{reset},
4981 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4982 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4983 @end deffn
4984
4985 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4986 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4987 currently associated with this target.
4988 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4989 @end deffn
4990
4991 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4992 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4993 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4994 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4995 @end deffn
4996
4997 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4998 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4999 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5000 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5001 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5002 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5003 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5004 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5005 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5006 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5007 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5008 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5009 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5010 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
5011 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
5012 @end deffn
5013
5014 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5015 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5016 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5017 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5018 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5019 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5020 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5021 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5022 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5023 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5024 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5025 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5026 @end deffn
5027
5028 @anchor{targetevents}
5029 @section Target Events
5030 @cindex target events
5031 @cindex events
5032 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5033 For example:
5034 @itemize @bullet
5035 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5036 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5037 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5038 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5039 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5040 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5041 to set up system clocks or
5042 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5043 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5044 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5045 @end itemize
5046
5047 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5048 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5049 @command{target create ... -event}.
5050
5051 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5052 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5053 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5054
5055 @example
5056 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5057 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5058 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5059 @}
5060 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5061 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5062 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5063 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5064 @}
5065 @end example
5066
5067 The following target events are defined:
5068
5069 @itemize @bullet
5070 @item @b{debug-halted}
5071 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5072 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5073 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5074 @item @b{early-halted}
5075 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5076 @item @b{examine-start}
5077 @* Before target examine is called.
5078 @item @b{examine-end}
5079 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5080 @item @b{examine-fail}
5081 @* After target examine fails.
5082 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5083 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5084 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5085 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5086 connect GDB to running target.
5087 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5088 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5089 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5090 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5091 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5092 is in RAM or read only memory.
5093 Default is @code{halt}
5094 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5095 @* When GDB disconnects
5096 @item @b{gdb-end}
5097 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5098 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5099 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5100 @code{reset init})
5101 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5102 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5103 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5104 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5105 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5106 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5107 @item @b{gdb-start}
5108 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5109 @item @b{halted}
5110 @* The target has halted
5111 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5112 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5113 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5114 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5115 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5116 @item @b{reset-assert}
5117 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5118 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5119 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5120 it instead of asserting SRST.
5121 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5122 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5123 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5124 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5125 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5126 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5127 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5128 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5129 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5130 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5131 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5132 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5133 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5134 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5135 released on the scan chain.
5136 @item @b{reset-end}
5137 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5138 @item @b{reset-init}
5139 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5140 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5141
5142 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5143 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5144 multiplexing, and so on.
5145 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5146 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5147 @item @b{reset-start}
5148 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5149 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5150
5151 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5152 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5153 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5154 @item @b{resume-start}
5155 @* Before any target is resumed
5156 @item @b{resume-end}
5157 @* After all targets have resumed
5158 @item @b{resumed}
5159 @* Target has resumed
5160 @item @b{step-start}
5161 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5162 @item @b{step-end}
5163 @* After single-step has completed
5164 @item @b{trace-config}
5165 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5166 @end itemize
5167
5168 @quotation Note
5169 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5170 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5171 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5172 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5173 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5174 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5175 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5176 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5177 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5178 check if the core has changed status.
5179 @end quotation
5180
5181 @node Flash Commands
5182 @chapter Flash Commands
5183
5184 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5185 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5186 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5187 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5188 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5189 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5190 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5191 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5192 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5193
5194 Flash Steps:
5195 @enumerate
5196 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5197 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5198 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5199 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5200 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5201 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5202 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5203 @item GDB Flashing
5204 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5205 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5206 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5207 @end enumerate
5208
5209 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5210 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5211 so that it can't boot.
5212 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5213 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5214
5215 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5216 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5217 @cindex flash configuration
5218
5219 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5220 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5221 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5222 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5223 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5224 see the driver-specific documentation.
5225
5226 @itemize @bullet
5227 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5228 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5229 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5230 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5231 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5232 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5233 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5234 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5235 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5236 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5237 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5238 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5239 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5240 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5241 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5242 commands to the flash controller.
5243 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5244 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5245 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5246 for more information.
5247 @end itemize
5248 @quotation Note
5249 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5250 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5251 @end quotation
5252 @end deffn
5253
5254 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5255 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5256 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5257 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5258 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5259 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5260 @end deffn
5261
5262 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5263 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5264 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5265 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5266 @end deffn
5267
5268 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5269 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5270 depends on the flash type.
5271 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5272 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5273 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5274 but most don't bother.
5275 @end deffn
5276
5277 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5278
5279 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5280 begins.
5281
5282 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5283 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5284 until the programming session is finished.
5285
5286 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5287 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5288
5289 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5290
5291 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5292 @cindex flash erasing
5293 @cindex flash reading
5294 @cindex flash writing
5295 @cindex flash programming
5296 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5297
5298 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5299 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5300 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5301 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5302 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5303
5304 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5305 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5306 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5307 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5308 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5309
5310 @quotation Note
5311 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5312 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5313 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5314 back to a flash bank.
5315 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5316 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5317 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5318 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5319 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5320 @end quotation
5321
5322 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5323 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5324 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5325 disabled first.
5326 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5327 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5328 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5329
5330 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5331 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5332 up to and including @var{last}.
5333 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5334 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5335 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5336 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5337 @end deffn
5338
5339 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5340 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5341 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5342 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5343 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5344 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5345 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5346 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5347 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5348 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5349 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5350 before erase starts.
5351 @end deffn
5352
5353 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5354 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5355 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5356 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5357 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5358 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5359 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5360 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5361 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5362 before issuing this command.
5363 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5364 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5365 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5366 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5367 @end deffn
5368 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5369
5370 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5371 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5372 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5373 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5374 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5375 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5376 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5377 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5378 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5379 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5380 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5381 @end deffn
5382
5383 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5384 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5385 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5386 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5387 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5388 @end deffn
5389
5390 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5391 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5392 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5393 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5394 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5395 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5396 @end deffn
5397
5398 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5399 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5400 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5401 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5402 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5403 @end deffn
5404
5405 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5406 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5407 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5408 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5409 to the base address for each section in the image.
5410 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5411 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5412 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5413 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5414 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5415 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5416 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5417 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5418 each image section.
5419
5420 @quotation Warning
5421 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5422 data you want to preserve.
5423 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5424 sections might be erased with no notice.
5425 @itemize
5426 @item
5427 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5428 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5429 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5430 @item
5431 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5432 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5433 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5434 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5435 @end itemize
5436 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5437 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5438 @end quotation
5439
5440 @end deffn
5441
5442 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5443 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5444 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5445 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5446 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5447 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5448 ordinary memory reads.
5449 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5450 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5451 check for successful programming.
5452 @end deffn
5453
5454 @section Other Flash commands
5455 @cindex flash protection
5456
5457 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5458 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5459 and display that status.
5460 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5461 @end deffn
5462
5463 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5464 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5465 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5466
5467 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5468 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5469 and possibly stale information.
5470 @end deffn
5471
5472 @anchor{flashprotect}
5473 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5474 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5475 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5476 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5477 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5478 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5479 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5480 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5481 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5482 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5483 @end deffn
5484
5485 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5486 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5487 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5488 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5489 @end deffn
5490
5491 @anchor{program}
5492 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5493 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5494 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5495 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5496 @end deffn
5497
5498 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5499 @section Flash Driver List
5500 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5501 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5502 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5503
5504 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5505 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5506 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5507
5508 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5509
5510 @itemize
5511 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5512 @end itemize
5513
5514 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5515 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5516 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5517 @example
5518 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5519 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5520 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5521 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5522 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5523 @end example
5524 @end deffn
5525
5526 @subsection External Flash
5527
5528 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5529 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5530 @cindex CFI
5531 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5532 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5533 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5534 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5535 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5536 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5537 configure a bus and its timings), or
5538 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5539 on the flash chip.
5540 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5541 speed up operation.
5542
5543 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5544
5545 @itemize
5546 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5547 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5548 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5549 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5550 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5551 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5552 @end itemize
5553
5554 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5555 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5556
5557 @example
5558 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5559 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5560 @end example
5561
5562 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5563 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5564 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5565
5566 @example
5567 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5568 @end example
5569
5570 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5571 @end deffn
5572
5573 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5574 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5575 @cindex SPI
5576 @cindex jtagspi
5577 @cindex bscan_spi
5578 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5579 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5580 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5581 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5582 accessed through JTAG.
5583
5584 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5585 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5586 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5587 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5588 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5589 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5590
5591 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5592 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5593 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5594 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5595 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5596 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5597 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5598 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5599
5600 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5601 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5602 command, see below.
5603
5604 @itemize
5605 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5606 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5607 @var{USER1} instruction.
5608 @end itemize
5609
5610 @example
5611 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5612 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5613 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5614 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5615 @end example
5616
5617 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5618 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5619 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5620 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5621 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5622 @example
5623 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5624 @end example
5625 @end deffn
5626
5627 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5628 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5629 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5630 @example
5631 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5632 @end example
5633 @end deffn
5634
5635 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5636 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5637 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5638 @end deffn
5639 @end deffn
5640
5641 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5642 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5643 @cindex xcf
5644 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5645 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5646 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5647 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5648 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5649
5650 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5651 command accepts additional parameters:
5652 @itemize
5653 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5654 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5655 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5656 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5657 in master mode.
5658 @end itemize
5659 @example
5660 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5661 @end example
5662 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5663 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5664 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5665 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5666 dedicated sector.
5667 @end deffn
5668
5669 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5670 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5671 button.
5672 @example
5673 xcf configure 0
5674 @end example
5675 @end deffn
5676
5677 Additional driver notes:
5678 @itemize
5679 @item Only single revision supported.
5680 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5681 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5682 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5683 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5684 @end itemize
5685 @end deffn
5686
5687 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5688 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5689 @cindex SPIFI
5690 @cindex lpcspifi
5691 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5692 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5693 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5694
5695 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5696 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5697 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5698 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5699 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5700
5701 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5702 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5703 are configured by the driver.
5704
5705 @example
5706 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5707 @end example
5708
5709 @end deffn
5710
5711 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5712 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5713 @cindex SMI
5714 @cindex stmsmi
5715 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5716 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5717 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5718 SPI flash devices.
5719 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5720 flash devices can be connected.
5721
5722 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5723 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5724 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5725 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5726 the flash content.
5727
5728 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5729 to identify the memory bank.
5730 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5731 flash size, are detected automatically.
5732
5733 @example
5734 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5735 @end example
5736
5737 @end deffn
5738
5739 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5740 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5741 @cindex QuadSPI
5742 @cindex OctoSPI
5743 @cindex stmqspi
5744 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5745 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5746 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5747 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5748 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5749 mode is not.
5750
5751 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5752 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5753 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5754 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5755
5756 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5757 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5758 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5759
5760 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5761 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5762 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5763 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5764 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5765 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5766
5767 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5768 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5769 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5770 should be avoided.
5771
5772 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5773 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5774 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5775 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5776 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5777 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5778
5779 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5780 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5781 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5782 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5783 persist across openocd invocations.
5784
5785 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5786 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5787 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5788 required (see 'set' command).
5789
5790 @example
5791 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5792 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5793 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5794 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5795 @end example
5796
5797 There are three specific commands
5798 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5799 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5800 chip specific write protection engaged.
5801 @end deffn
5802
5803 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5804 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5805 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5806 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5807 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5808 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5809
5810 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5811 which don't support an id command.
5812
5813 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5814 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5815 @end deffn
5816
5817 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5818 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5819 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5820 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5821 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5822
5823 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5824 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5825 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5826 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5827
5828 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5829
5830 To check basic communication settings, issue
5831 @example
5832 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5833 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5834 @end example
5835 for single flash mode or
5836 @example
5837 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5838 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5839 @end example
5840 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5841
5842 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5843 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5844 need a dummy address, e.g.
5845 @example
5846 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5847 @end example
5848 should return the status register contents.
5849
5850 @end deffn
5851
5852 @end deffn
5853
5854 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5855 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5856 Microcontroller platform.
5857
5858 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5859 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5860
5861 @example
5862 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5863 @end example
5864
5865 @end deffn
5866
5867 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5868 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5869 @cindex ath79
5870 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5871 chip selects.
5872 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5873 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5874 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5875 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5876 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5877 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5878
5879 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5880 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5881 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5882 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5883 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5884 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5885 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5886 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5887 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5888 with the default CS0.
5889 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5890 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5891 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5892
5893 @example
5894 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5895
5896 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5897 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5898 # distinguish the banks.
5899 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5900 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5901 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5902 @end example
5903
5904 @end deffn
5905
5906 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5907 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5908 @cindex fespi
5909
5910 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5911
5912 @example
5913 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5914 @end example
5915 @end deffn
5916
5917 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5918
5919 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5920 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5921 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5922 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5923 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5924 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5925
5926 @example
5927 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5928 @end example
5929 @end deffn
5930
5931 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5932 @cindex ambiqmicro
5933 @cindex apollo
5934 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5935 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5936 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5937 with the target using SWD.
5938
5939 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5940 the device class of the MCU.
5941 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5942 to set up the flash banks.
5943 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5944 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5945
5946 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5947 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5948 and the second bank starts after the first.
5949
5950 @example
5951 # Flash bank 0
5952 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5953 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5954 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5955 $_TARGETNAME
5956 @end example
5957
5958 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5959 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5960 are available to the user.
5961
5962 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5963
5964 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5965 Erase entire bank.
5966 @end deffn
5967 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5968 Erase device pages.
5969 @end deffn
5970 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5971 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5972 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5973 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5974 the flash.
5975 @end deffn
5976 @end deffn
5977
5978 @anchor{at91samd}
5979 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5980 @cindex at91samd
5981 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5982 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5983
5984 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5985
5986 The devices have one flash bank:
5987
5988 @example
5989 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5990 @end example
5991
5992 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5993 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5994 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5995 processor to be halted.
5996 @end deffn
5997
5998 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5999 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6000 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6001 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6002 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6003 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6004
6005 @example
6006 at91samd set-security enable
6007 @end example
6008 @end deffn
6009
6010 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6011 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6012 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6013 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6014 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6015 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6016 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6017 in order to disable this feature.
6018
6019 @example
6020 at91samd eeprom
6021 at91samd eeprom 1024
6022 @end example
6023 @end deffn
6024
6025 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6026 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6027 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6028 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6029 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6030 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6031
6032 @example
6033 at91samd bootloader
6034 at91samd bootloader 16384
6035 @end example
6036 @end deffn
6037
6038 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6039 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6040 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6041 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6042 @end deffn
6043
6044 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6045 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6046 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6047 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6048 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6049 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6050 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6051 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6052
6053 @example
6054 # Read user row
6055 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6056 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6057 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6058 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6059 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6060 # byte unchanged
6061 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6062 @end example
6063 @end deffn
6064
6065 @end deffn
6066
6067 @anchor{at91sam3}
6068 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6069 @cindex at91sam3
6070 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6071 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6072 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6073 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6074 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6075 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6076 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6077 chips are confirmed.}
6078
6079 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6080 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6081 the following fixed locations:
6082
6083 @example
6084 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6085 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6086 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6087 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6088 @end example
6089
6090 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6091 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6092 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6093
6094 @itemize
6095 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6096 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6097 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6098 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6099 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6100 @end itemize
6101
6102 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6103
6104 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6105 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6106 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6107 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6108 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6109 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6110 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6111
6112 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6113 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6114 @end deffn
6115
6116 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6117 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6118 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6119 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6120 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6121 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6122 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6123 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6124 @end deffn
6125
6126 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6127 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6128 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6129 @end deffn
6130 @end deffn
6131
6132 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6133 @cindex at91sam4
6134 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6135 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6136 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6137 @end deffn
6138
6139 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6140 @cindex at91sam4l
6141 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6142 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6143 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6144
6145 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6146 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6147 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6148 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6149 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6150 @end deffn
6151 @end deffn
6152
6153 @anchor{atsame5}
6154 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6155 @cindex atsame5
6156 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6157 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6158 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6159
6160 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6161 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6162 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6163
6164 @example
6165 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6166 @end example
6167
6168 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6169 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6170 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6171 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6172 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6173 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6174
6175 @example
6176 atsame5 bootloader
6177 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6178 @end example
6179 @end deffn
6180
6181 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6182 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6183 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6184 processor to be halted.
6185 @end deffn
6186
6187 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6188 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6189 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6190 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6191 @end deffn
6192
6193 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6194 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6195 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6196 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6197 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6198 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6199 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6200 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6201
6202 @example
6203 # Read
6204 >atsame5 userpage
6205 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6206 # Write
6207 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6208 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6209 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6210 # bytes)
6211 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6212 @end example
6213 @end deffn
6214
6215 @end deffn
6216
6217 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6218 @cindex atsamv
6219 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6220 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6221 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6222 @end deffn
6223
6224 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6225 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6226 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6227 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6228 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6229
6230 @example
6231 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6232 @end example
6233
6234 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6235 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6236
6237 @itemize
6238 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6239 @item @var{banks}
6240 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6241 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6242 @item @var{pages_size}
6243 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6244 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6245 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6246 @end itemize
6247
6248 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6249 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6250 will be autoconfigured.
6251 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6252
6253 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6254 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6255 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6256 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6257 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6258
6259 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6260 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6261 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6262 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6263 are not truly general purpose).
6264 @quotation Note
6265 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6266 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6267 @end quotation
6268 @end deffn
6269 @end deffn
6270
6271 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6272 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6273 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6274 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6275 @end deffn
6276
6277 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6278 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6279 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6280 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6281
6282 @example
6283 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6284 @end example
6285
6286 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6287 each single sector one by one.
6288
6289 @example
6290 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6291 @end example
6292
6293 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6294 @end deffn
6295
6296 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6297 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6298 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6299 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6300 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6301 starts at address 0.
6302
6303 @example
6304 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6305 @end example
6306 @end deffn
6307
6308 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6309 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6310 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6311 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6312 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6313 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6314 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6315 and programming the serial flash.
6316
6317 @example
6318 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6319 @end example
6320 @end deffn
6321
6322 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6323 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6324 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6325 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6326 autoconfigures itself.
6327 @example
6328 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6329 @end example
6330 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6331 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6332 this via the following command:
6333 @example
6334 efm32 debuglock num
6335 @end example
6336 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6337 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6338 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6339 supported.}
6340 @end deffn
6341
6342 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6343 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6344 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6345 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6346 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6347 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6348
6349 @example
6350 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6351 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6352 @end example
6353
6354 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6355 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6356 @end deffn
6357
6358 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6359 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6360 is an uncommon operation.}
6361 @end deffn
6362 @end deffn
6363
6364 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6365 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6366 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6367 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6368 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6369 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6370 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6371
6372 @example
6373 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6374 @end example
6375 @end deffn
6376
6377 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6378 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6379 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6380 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6381 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6382 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6383 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6384 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6385 characters) ignored.
6386
6387 @example
6388 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6389 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6390 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6391 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6392 @end example
6393 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6394 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6398 @cindex kinetis
6399 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6400 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6401 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6402 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6403 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6404 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6405
6406 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6407 @itemize
6408 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6409 @end itemize
6410
6411 @example
6412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6413 @end example
6414
6415 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6416 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6417 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6418 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6419 @end deffn
6420
6421 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6422 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6423 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6424 set by 'flash protect' command.
6425 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6426 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6427 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6428 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6429 with the rest of a flash image.
6430 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6431 @end deffn
6432
6433 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6434 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6435 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6439 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6440 and examine-fail event.
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6444 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6445 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6446 @end deffn
6447
6448 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6449 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6450 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6451 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6452 command completes.
6453 @end deffn
6454
6455 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6456 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6457 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6458 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6459 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6460
6461 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6462 Program Partition command.
6463
6464 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6465 Reset the device after partition setting.
6466
6467 Show partition size:
6468 @example
6469 kinetis nvm_partition info
6470 @end example
6471
6472 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6473 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6474 @example
6475 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6476 @end example
6477
6478 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6479 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6480 @example
6481 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6482 @end example
6483 @end deffn
6484
6485 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6486 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6487 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6488 @end deffn
6489
6490 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6491 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6492 Command disables watchdog timer.
6493 @end deffn
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6497 @cindex kinetis_ke
6498 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6499 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6500 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6501 autoconfigures itself.
6502 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6503
6504 @example
6505 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6506 @end example
6507
6508 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6509 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6510 @end deffn
6511
6512 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6513 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6514 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6515 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6516 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6517 @end deffn
6518
6519 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6520 Command disables watchdog timer.
6521 @end deffn
6522 @end deffn
6523
6524 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6525 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6526 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6527 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6528 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6529
6530 @quotation Note
6531 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6532 driver:
6533 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6534 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6535 @end quotation
6536
6537 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6538 which must appear in the following order:
6539
6540 @itemize
6541 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6542 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6543 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6544 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6545 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6546 LPC43x[2357])
6547 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6548 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6549 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6550 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6551 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6552 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6553 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6554 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6555 at which the core is running
6556 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6557 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6558 @quotation Note
6559 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6560 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6561 However, if you do provide it,
6562 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6563 @end quotation
6564 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6565 ROM IAP entry point.
6566 @end itemize
6567
6568 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6569
6570 @example
6571 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6572 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6573 @end example
6574
6575 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6576 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6577 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6578 @end deffn
6579 @end deffn
6580
6581 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6582 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6583 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6584 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6585 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6586 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6587
6588 @example
6589 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6590 @end example
6591 @end deffn
6592
6593 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6594 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6595 from NXP.
6596
6597 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6598 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6599 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6600 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6601 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6602 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6603 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6604 you start the PLL.
6605
6606 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6607
6608 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6609 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6610 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6611
6612 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6613 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6614 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6615 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6616 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6617 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6618 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6619
6620 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6621 @example
6622 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6623 @end example
6624
6625 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6626 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6627 @code{flash banks} command.
6628
6629 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6630 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6631 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6632 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6633 a known signature.
6634 Example:
6635 @example
6636 lpc2900 signature 0
6637 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6638 @end example
6639 @end deffn
6640
6641 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6642 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6643 saves it to a file in binary format.
6644 Example:
6645 @example
6646 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6647 @end example
6648 @end deffn
6649
6650 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6651 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6652 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6653 command:
6654
6655 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6656 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6657 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6658 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6659
6660 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6661 Example:
6662 @example
6663 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6664 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6665 @end example
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6669 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6670 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6671 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6672 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6673 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6674 912 bytes.
6675 @quotation Attention
6676 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6677 @end quotation
6678 Example:
6679 @example
6680 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6681 @end example
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6685 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6686 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6687 after the next power cycle.
6688 @quotation Attention
6689 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6690 @end quotation
6691 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6692 Example:
6693 @example
6694 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6695 flash info 0
6696 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6697 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6698 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6699 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6700 @end example
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6704 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6705 effective after the next power cycle.
6706 @quotation Attention
6707 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6708 @end quotation
6709 Examples:
6710 @example
6711 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6712 @end example
6713 @end deffn
6714 @end deffn
6715
6716 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6717 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6718 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6719 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6720
6721 @example
6722 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6723 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6724 @end example
6725
6726 @itemize @bullet
6727 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6728 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6729 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6730 @end itemize
6731
6732 Example usage:
6733 @example
6734 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6735 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6736 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6737 @} else @{
6738 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6739 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6740 @}
6741 @end example
6742 @end deffn
6743
6744 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6745 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6746 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6747 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6748 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6749 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6750
6751 @example
6752 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6753 @end example
6754
6755 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6756 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6757 only the main program flash.
6758
6759 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6760 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6761 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6762 @end deffn
6763
6764 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6765 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6766 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6767 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6768
6769 To erase and program the BSL:
6770 @example
6771 msp432 bsl unlock
6772 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6773 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6774 msp432 bsl lock
6775 @end example
6776 @end deffn
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6780 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6781 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6782 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6783 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6784 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6785 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6786 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6787 also have division into regions: main and info.
6788 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6789 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6790
6791 @example
6792 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6793 @end example
6794
6795 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6796
6797 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6798 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6799 @end deffn
6800
6801 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6802 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6806 Erase all userflash including info region.
6807 @end deffn
6808
6809 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6810 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6811 @end deffn
6812
6813 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6814 Check sectors protect.
6815 @end deffn
6816
6817 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6818 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6819 @end deffn
6820
6821 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6822 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6826 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6830 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6831 @end deffn
6832
6833 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6834 Show information about flash driver.
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @end deffn
6838
6839 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6840 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6841 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6842 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6843 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6844
6845 @example
6846 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6847 @end example
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6851 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6852 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6853 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6854 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6855
6856 @example
6857 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6858 @end example
6859
6860 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6861
6862 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6863 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6864 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6865 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6866 code.
6867 @end deffn
6868
6869 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6870 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6876 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6877 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6878
6879 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6880 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6881 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6882 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6883
6884 @example
6885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6886 @end example
6887 @end deffn
6888
6889 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6890 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6891 and integrate flash memory.
6892
6893 @example
6894 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6895 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6896 @end example
6897
6898 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6899 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6900 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6901 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6902 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6903 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6904 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6905 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6906 @end deffn
6907 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6908 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6909 This will remove any Code Protection.
6910 @end deffn
6911 @end deffn
6912
6913 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6914 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6915 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6916 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6917 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6918
6919 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6920 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6921
6922 @example
6923 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6924 @end example
6925
6926 psoc4-specific commands
6927 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6928 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6929
6930 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6931 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6932
6933 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6934 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6935 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6936
6937 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6938 @end deffn
6939
6940 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6941 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6942
6943 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6944 @end deffn
6945 @end deffn
6946
6947 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6948 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6949 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6950 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6951 apart from the base address.
6952
6953 @example
6954 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6955 @end example
6956
6957 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6958 @quotation Attention
6959 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6960 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6961 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6962 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6963 @end quotation
6964
6965 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6966
6967 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6968 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6969 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6970 @end deffn
6971 @end deffn
6972
6973 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6974 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6975 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6976 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6977 apart from the base address.
6978
6979 @example
6980 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6981 $_TARGETNAME
6982 @end example
6983 @end deffn
6984
6985 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6986 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6987 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6988 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6989
6990 @example
6991 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6992 @end example
6993
6994 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6995
6996 @itemize
6997 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6998 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6999 @end itemize
7000
7001 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7002
7003 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7004 @quotation Attention
7005 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7006 after successful write.
7007 @end quotation
7008 @end deffn
7009
7010 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7011 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7012 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7013 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7014
7015 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7016 @itemize @bullet
7017 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7018 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7019 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7020 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7021 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7022 row size: 512 bytes.
7023 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7024 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7025 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7026 operation will erase row automatically.
7027 @end itemize
7028
7029 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7030 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7031
7032 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7033
7034 @example
7035 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7036 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7037 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7038 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7039 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7040 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7041 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7042 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7043 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7044 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7045 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7046 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7047
7048 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7049 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7050 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7051 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7052 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7053 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7054 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7055 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7056 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7057 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7058 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7059 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7060 @end example
7061
7062 psoc6-specific commands
7063 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7064 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7065 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7066 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7067 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7068 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7072 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7073 by @command{flash banks}.
7074 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7075 @end deffn
7076 @end deffn
7077
7078 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7079 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7080 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7081 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7082 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7083
7084 @example
7085 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7086 @end example
7087 @end deffn
7088
7089 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7090 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7091 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7092 and SWD interface.
7093 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7094 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7095
7096 @example
7097 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7098 @end example
7099
7100 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7101
7102 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7103 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7104 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7105 @end deffn
7106
7107 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7108 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7109 @end deffn
7110 @end deffn
7111
7112 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7113 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7114 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7115 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7116 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7117
7118 @example
7119 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7120 @end example
7121
7122 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7123 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7124 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7125 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7126 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7127 disabled.
7128
7129 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7130 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7131 @quotation Warning
7132 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7133 applied to all of them.
7134 @end quotation
7135 @end deffn
7136 @end deffn
7137
7138 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7139 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7140 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7141 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7142 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7143 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7144
7145 @example
7146 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7147 @end example
7148
7149 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7150 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7151 the flash driver.
7152
7153 @example
7154 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7155 @end example
7156
7157 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7158 as per the following example.
7159 @example
7160 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7161 @end example
7162
7163 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7164
7165 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7166 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7167 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7168 @end deffn
7169
7170 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7171 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7172 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7173 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7174 @end deffn
7175
7176 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7177 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7178 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7179 @end deffn
7180
7181 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7182 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7183 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7184 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7185 @end deffn
7186
7187 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7188 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7189 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7190 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7191 @end deffn
7192
7193 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7194 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7195 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7196 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7197 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7198 @end deffn
7199 @end deffn
7200
7201 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7202 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7203 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7204 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7205 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7206
7207 @example
7208 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7209 @end example
7210
7211 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7212 as per the following example.
7213 @example
7214 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7215 @end example
7216
7217 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7218 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7219 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7220 @end deffn
7221
7222 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7223 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7224 the flash driver.
7225
7226 @example
7227 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7228 @end example
7229
7230 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7231
7232 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7233 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7234 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7238 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7239 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7243 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7244 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7245 @end deffn
7246
7247 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7248 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7249 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7250 @end deffn
7251
7252 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7253 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7254 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7255 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7256 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7257 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7258 @end deffn
7259
7260 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7261 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7262 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7263 @end deffn
7264 @end deffn
7265
7266 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7267 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7268 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7269 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7270 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7271
7272 @example
7273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7274 @end example
7275
7276 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7277 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7278 the flash driver.
7279
7280 @example
7281 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7282 @end example
7283
7284 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7285
7286 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7287 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7289 @end deffn
7290
7291 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7292 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7293 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7294 @end deffn
7295
7296 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7297 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7298 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7299 @end deffn
7300
7301 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7302 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7303 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7304 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7305 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7306
7307 Example usage:
7308 @example
7309 # read OPTSR_CUR
7310 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7311 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7312 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7313 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7314 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7315 @end example
7316 @end deffn
7317
7318 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7319 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7320 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7321 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7322 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7323 will be touched).
7324
7325 Example usage:
7326 @example
7327 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7328 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7329 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7330 @end example
7331 @end deffn
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7335 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7336 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7337 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7338 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7339
7340 @example
7341 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7342 @end example
7343
7344 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7345 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7346 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7347 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7348 second bank.
7349
7350 @example
7351 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7352 @end example
7353
7354 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7355
7356 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7357 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7358 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7359 @end deffn
7360
7361 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7362 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7363 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7367 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7368 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7369 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7370 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7371 @end deffn
7372 @end deffn
7373
7374 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7375 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7376 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7377 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7378 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7379 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7380
7381 @example
7382 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7383 @end example
7384
7385 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7386 as per the following example.
7387 @example
7388 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7389 @end example
7390
7391 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7392 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7393 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7397 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7398 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7399 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7400
7401 @example
7402 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7403 @end example
7404
7405 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7406
7407 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7408 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7409 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7410
7411 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7415 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7416 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7417
7418 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7422 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7423 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7424 @end deffn
7425
7426 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7427 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7428 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7429 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7430
7431 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7432 @example
7433 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7434 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7435 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7436 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7437 @end example
7438
7439 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7440 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7444 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7445 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7446 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7447 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7448
7449 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7450
7451 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7452 @example
7453 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7454 @end example
7455
7456 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7457 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7458 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7459 @end deffn
7460
7461 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7462 List the protected areas using WRP.
7463 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7464 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7465 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7466
7467 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7468 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7469 in single or dual-banks mode.
7470 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7471 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7472
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7476 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7477 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7481 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7482 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7483 the TrustZone status.
7484 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7485 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7486 @end deffn
7487 @end deffn
7488
7489 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7490 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7491 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7492 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7493 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7494
7495 @example
7496 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7497 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7498 @end example
7499
7500 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7501 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7502 for the specified flash bank.
7503 @end deffn
7504 @end deffn
7505
7506 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7507 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7508 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7509 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7510 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7511
7512 @example
7513 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7514 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7515 @end example
7516
7517 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7518 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7519 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7520
7521 @itemize @bullet
7522 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7523 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7524 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7525 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7526 @end itemize
7527 @end deffn
7528
7529 @end deffn
7530
7531 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7532 @cindex str9xpec
7533
7534 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7535 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7536 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7537 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7538
7539 Here is some background info to help
7540 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7541 the str9:
7542 @enumerate
7543 @item
7544 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7545 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7546 @item
7547 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7548 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7549 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7550 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7551 @end enumerate
7552
7553 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7554 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7555 configured for flash bank 0.
7556 @example
7557 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7558 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7559 adapter assert srst
7560 # turn off target polling
7561 poll off
7562 # disable str9 core
7563 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7564 # read option bytes
7565 str9xpec options_read 0
7566 # re-enable str9 core
7567 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7568 poll on
7569 reset halt
7570 @end example
7571 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7572 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7573 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7574 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7575
7576 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7577
7578 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7579 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7580 @end deffn
7581
7582 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7583 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7584 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7585 @end deffn
7586
7587 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7588 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7589 erase the device.
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7593 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7597 Configure str9 boot bank.
7598 @end deffn
7599
7600 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7601 Configure str9 lvd source.
7602 @end deffn
7603
7604 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7605 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7609 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7610 @end deffn
7611
7612 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7613 Read str9 option bytes.
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7617 Write str9 option bytes.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7621 unlock str9 device.
7622 @end deffn
7623
7624 @end deffn
7625
7626 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7627 @cindex swm050
7628 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7629
7630 @example
7631 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7632 @end example
7633
7634 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7635
7636 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7637 Erases the entire flash bank.
7638 @end deffn
7639
7640 @end deffn
7641
7642
7643 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7644 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7645 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7646 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7647
7648 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7649
7650 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7651 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7652 @end deffn
7653
7654 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7655 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7656 @end deffn
7657
7658 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7659 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7660 the flash clock.
7661 @end deffn
7662 @end deffn
7663
7664 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7665 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7666 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7667 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7668 correct bank config.
7669
7670 @example
7671 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7672 @end example
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7676 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7677 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7678 @end deffn
7679
7680 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7681 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7682 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7683
7684 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7685
7686 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7687 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7688 @end deffn
7689
7690 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7691 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7692 @end deffn
7693
7694 @end deffn
7695
7696 @section NAND Flash Commands
7697 @cindex NAND
7698
7699 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7700 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7701 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7702
7703 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7704 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7705 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7706 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7707 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7708 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7709
7710 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7711 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7712 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7713 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7714 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7715 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7716 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7717 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7718 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7719 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7720
7721 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7722 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7723 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7724 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7725 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7726 every 512 bytes of data.
7727
7728 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7729 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7730 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7731 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7732 ECC mode is used.
7733
7734 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7735 @enumerate
7736 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7737 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7738 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7739 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7740 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7741 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7742 to access that device.
7743 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7744 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7745 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7746 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7747 de-brick a board.
7748 @end enumerate
7749
7750 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7751 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7752 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7753 are only 32 bits wide.
7754 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7755 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7756 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7757 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7758
7759 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7760 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7761 @cindex NAND configuration
7762
7763 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7764 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7765 OpenOCD has initialized.
7766
7767 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7768 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7769 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7770 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7771 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7772 they were a single (larger) device.
7773 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7774 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7775
7776 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7777 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7778 configuration files, not interactively.
7779
7780 @itemize @bullet
7781 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7782 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7783 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7784 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7785 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7786 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7787 commands to the NAND controller.
7788 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7789 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7790 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7791 for more information.
7792 @end itemize
7793 @end deffn
7794
7795 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7796 Prints a summary of each device declared
7797 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7798 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7799 @example
7800 > nand list
7801 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7802 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7803 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7804 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7805 >
7806 @end example
7807 @end deffn
7808
7809 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7810 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7811 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7812 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7813 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7814 it with most other NAND commands.
7815 @end deffn
7816
7817 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7818
7819 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7820 @cindex NAND reading
7821 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7822 starting at the specified offset.
7823 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7824
7825 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7826 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7827
7828 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7829 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7830 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7831
7832 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7833 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7834 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7835 method which handled that error correction.
7836
7837 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7838 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7839 @itemize @bullet
7840 @item no oob_* parameter
7841 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7842 @item @code{oob_raw}
7843 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7844 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7845 spare areas associated with each data page.
7846 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7847 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7848 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7849 @item @code{oob_only}
7850 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7851 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7852 spare areas associated with each data page.
7853 @end itemize
7854 @end deffn
7855
7856 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7857 @cindex NAND erasing
7858 @cindex NAND programming
7859 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7860 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7861 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7862 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7863 If those parameters are not specified,
7864 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7865 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7866
7867 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7868 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7869 block marker.
7870 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7871 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7872 @end deffn
7873
7874 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7875 @cindex NAND writing
7876 @cindex NAND programming
7877 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7878 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7879 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7880 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7881
7882 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7883 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7884
7885 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7886 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7887 past the end of the device.
7888 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7889 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7890 if that's being written.)
7891
7892 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7893 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7894 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7895
7896 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7897 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7898 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7899 @itemize @bullet
7900 @item no oob_* parameter
7901 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7902 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7903 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7904 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7905 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7906 @item @code{oob_only}
7907 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7908 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7909 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7910 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7911 @item @code{oob_raw}
7912 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7913 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7914 un-altered OOB.
7915 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7916 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7917 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7918 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7919 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7920 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7921 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7922 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7923 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7924 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7925 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7926 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7927 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7928 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7929 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7930 @end itemize
7931 @end deffn
7932
7933 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7934 @cindex NAND verification
7935 @cindex NAND programming
7936 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7937 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7938 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7939
7940 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7941 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7942
7943 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7944 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7945 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7946 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7947 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7948
7949 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7950 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7951 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7952
7953 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7954 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7955 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7956 be removed in a future release.
7957 @end deffn
7958
7959 @subsection Other NAND commands
7960 @cindex NAND other commands
7961
7962 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7963 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7964 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7965 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7966 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7967 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7968 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7969 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7970
7971 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7972 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7973 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7974 @end deffn
7975
7976 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7977 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7978 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7979 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7980 status for each block.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7984 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7985 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7986
7987 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7988 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7989 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7990 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7991 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7992
7993 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7994 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7995 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7996 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7997 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7998 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7999 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8000 @end deffn
8001
8002 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8003 @subsection NAND Driver List
8004 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8005 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8006 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8007
8008 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8009 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8010 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8011 address of the ECC controller.
8012 @example
8013 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8014 @end example
8015 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8016 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8017 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8018 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8019 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8020 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8021 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8022 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8023 @end deffn
8024 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8025 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8026 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8027 @end deffn
8028
8029 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8030 properly configured for input or output.
8031 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8032 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8033 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8034 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8035 @end deffn
8036 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8037 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8038 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8039 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8040 @end deffn
8041 @end deffn
8042
8043 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8044 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8045 chips from Texas Instruments.
8046 It takes three extra parameters:
8047 address of the NAND chip;
8048 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8049 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8050 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8051 @example
8052 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8053 @end example
8054 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8055 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8056 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8057 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8058 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8059 @end deffn
8060
8061 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8062 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8063 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8064 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8065 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8066 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8067 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8068 @end deffn
8069
8070 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8071 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8072 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8073 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8074 @end deffn
8075 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8076
8077 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8078 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8079 should work for this chip as well.
8080 @end deffn
8081
8082 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8083 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8084 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8085 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8086 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8087 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8088 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8089 @example
8090 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8091 @end example
8092 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8093 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8094 without parameter query status.
8095 @end deffn
8096 @end deffn
8097
8098 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8099 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8100 parameter: the address of the controller.
8101 @example
8102 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8103 @end example
8104 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8105 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8106 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8107 change any behavior.
8108 @end deffn
8109
8110 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8111 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8112 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8113 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8114 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8115 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8116 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8117 specialized commands.
8118 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8119 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8120 change any behavior.
8121 @end deffn
8122
8123 @node Flash Programming
8124 @chapter Flash Programming
8125
8126 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8127 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8128 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8129
8130 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8131 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8132
8133 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8134 @enumerate
8135 @item 'init' is executed.
8136 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8137 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8138 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8139 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8140 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8141 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8142 @end enumerate
8143
8144 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8145
8146 @example
8147 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8148 # are optional parameters
8149 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8150 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8151
8152 # binary files need the flash address passing
8153 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8154 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8155 @end example
8156
8157 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8158 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8159 @cindex PLD
8160 @cindex FPGA
8161
8162 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8163 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8164 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8165 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8166 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8167 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8168 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8169
8170 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8171
8172 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8173 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8174 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8175
8176 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8177 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8178
8179 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8180 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8181 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8182 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8183 behavior.
8184 @end deffn
8185
8186 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8187 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8188 @end deffn
8189
8190 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8191 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8192 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8193 @end deffn
8194
8195 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8196
8197 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8198 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8199 that particular type of PLD.
8200
8201 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8202 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8203 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8204
8205 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8206 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8207 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8208
8209 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8210 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8211 for FPGA @var{num}.
8212 @end deffn
8213 @end deffn
8214
8215 @node General Commands
8216 @chapter General Commands
8217 @cindex commands
8218
8219 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8220 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8221 commands are documented elsewhere.
8222
8223 Intent:
8224 @itemize @bullet
8225 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8226 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8227 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8228 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8229
8230 @item @b{From the human}
8231 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8232 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8233
8234 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8235 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8236 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8237
8238 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8239 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8240 port is 5555.
8241 @end itemize
8242
8243
8244 @section Server Commands
8245
8246 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8247 Exits the current telnet session.
8248 @end deffn
8249
8250 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8251 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8252 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8253 Not every command provides helptext.
8254
8255 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8256 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8257 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8258 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8259 @end deffn
8260
8261 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8262 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8263 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8264 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8265 Useful in connection with script files
8266 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8270 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8271 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8272 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8273
8274 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8275 @example
8276 # redefine shutdown
8277 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8278 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8279 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8280 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8281 original_shutdown
8282 @}
8283 @end example
8284 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8285 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8286 @end deffn
8287
8288 @anchor{debuglevel}
8289 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8290 @cindex message level
8291 Display debug level.
8292 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8293 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8294 Level 0 is error messages only;
8295 level 1 adds warnings;
8296 level 2 adds informational messages;
8297 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8298 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8299 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8300 the command line along with the location of that log
8301 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8302 @xref{Running}.
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8306 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8307 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8308 @example
8309 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8310 @end example
8311 @end deffn
8312
8313 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8314 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8315 the default log output channel is stderr.
8316 @end deffn
8317
8318 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8319 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8320 @end deffn
8321
8322 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8323 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8324 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8325 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8326 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8327 @end deffn
8328
8329 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8330 @section Target State handling
8331 @cindex reset
8332 @cindex halt
8333 @cindex target initialization
8334
8335 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8336 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8337 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8338 a current target which is used to perform the
8339 various operations. The current target may be changed
8340 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8341 target which should become current.
8342
8343 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8344 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8345 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8346 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8347 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8348
8349 @emph{With no arguments}:
8350 list all available registers for the current target,
8351 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8352 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8353 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8354 are flagged as such.
8355
8356 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8357 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8358 bypassing any internal cache.
8359
8360 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8361 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8362 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8363 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8364 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8365 relevant module will flush such values.
8366
8367 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8368 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8369
8370 @example
8371 > reg
8372 ===== ARM registers
8373 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8374 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8375 (2) r2 (/32)
8376 ...
8377 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8378 >
8379 @end example
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8383 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8384 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8385 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8386 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8387 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8388 (and enter debug mode).
8389 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8390
8391 @quotation Warning
8392 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8393 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8394 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8395 power mode by gating the core clock;
8396 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8397
8398 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8399 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8400 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8401 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8402 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8403 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8404
8405 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8406 work with a JTAG debugger.
8407 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8408 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8409 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8410 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8411 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8412 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8413 @end quotation
8414
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8418 Resume the target at its current code position,
8419 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8420 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8421 @end deffn
8422
8423 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8424 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8425 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8426 @end deffn
8427
8428 @anchor{resetcommand}
8429 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8430 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8431 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8432 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8433 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8434 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8435 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8436
8437 The optional parameter specifies what should
8438 happen after the reset.
8439 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8440 The other options will not work on all systems.
8441 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8442
8443 @itemize @minus
8444 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8445 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8446 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8447 @end itemize
8448 @end deffn
8449
8450 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8451 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8452 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8453 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8454 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8455 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8456 state.
8457 @end deffn
8458
8459 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8460 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8461 Set values of reset signals.
8462 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8463 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8464 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8465 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8466
8467 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8468 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8469 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8470 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8471 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8472 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8473 the signal will not be modified.
8474
8475 @quotation Note
8476 TRST is specially handled.
8477 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8478 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8479 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8480 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8481 instead of the TRST signal.
8482 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8483 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8484 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8485 with handlers for that event.
8486 @end quotation
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8490 @section Memory access commands
8491 @cindex memory access
8492
8493 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8494 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8495 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8496 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8497
8498 @enumerate
8499 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8500 to change the current target.
8501 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8502 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8503 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8504 @end enumerate
8505
8506 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8507 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8508 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8509 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8510 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8511 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8512 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8513 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8514 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8515 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8516 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8517 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8518 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8519 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8520 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8521 @end deffn
8522
8523 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8524 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8525 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8526 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8527 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8528 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8529 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8530 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8531 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8532 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8533 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8534 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8535 @end deffn
8536
8537 @anchor{imageaccess}
8538 @section Image loading commands
8539 @cindex image loading
8540 @cindex image dumping
8541
8542 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8543 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8544 binary file named @var{filename}.
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8548 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8549 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8550 @end deffn
8551
8552 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8553 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8554 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8555 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8556 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8557 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8558 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8559 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8560 separately.
8561 @end deffn
8562
8563 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8564 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8565 The file format may optionally be specified
8566 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8567 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8568 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8569 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8570 @example
8571 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8572 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8573 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8574 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8575 $address $length
8576 @}
8577 @end example
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8581 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8582 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8583 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8584 The file format may optionally be specified
8585 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8586 @end deffn
8587
8588 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8589 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8590 The file format may optionally be specified
8591 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8592 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8593 @end deffn
8594
8595 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8596 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8597 The file format may optionally be specified
8598 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8599 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8600 @end deffn
8601
8602
8603 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8604 @cindex breakpoint
8605 @cindex watchpoint
8606
8607 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8608 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8609 watchpoints.
8610 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8611
8612 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8613 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8614 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8615 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8616 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8617 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8618
8619 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8620 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8621 @end deffn
8622
8623 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8624 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8625 @end deffn
8626
8627 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8628 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8629 @end deffn
8630
8631 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8632 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8633 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8634 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8635 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8636 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8637 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8638 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8639 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8640 @end deffn
8641
8642
8643 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8644
8645 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8646 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8647 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8648 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8649 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8650 running, can be used.
8651 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8652 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8653 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8654
8655 @quotation Note
8656 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8657 @end quotation
8658
8659 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8660 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8661 communication, respectively.
8662
8663 @quotation Note
8664 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8665 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8666 example.
8667 @end quotation
8668
8669 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8670 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8671 of TCP/IP connections.
8672
8673 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8674 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8675 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8676 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8677 @var{size} bytes.
8678 @end deffn
8679
8680 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8681 Start RTT.
8682 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8683 @end deffn
8684
8685 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8686 Stop RTT.
8687 @end deffn
8688
8689 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8690 Display the polling interval.
8691 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8692 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8693 checked for new data.
8694 @end deffn
8695
8696 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8697 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8698 @end deffn
8699
8700 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8701 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8702 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8703 @end deffn
8704
8705 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8706 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8707 @end deffn
8708
8709 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8710 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8714 on the target device.
8715
8716 @example
8717 resume
8718
8719 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8720 rtt start
8721
8722 rtt server start 9090 0
8723 @end example
8724
8725 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8726 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8727 TCP/IP port 9090.
8728
8729
8730 @section Misc Commands
8731
8732 @cindex profiling
8733 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8734 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8735 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8736 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8737 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8738 limit the address range.
8739 @end deffn
8740
8741 @deffn {Command} {version}
8742 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8743 @end deffn
8744
8745 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8746 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8747 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8748 @end deffn
8749
8750 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8751 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8752 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8753 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8754
8755 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8756 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8757 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8758 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8759
8760 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8761 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8762 @cindex tracing
8763 @cindex ETM
8764 @cindex ETB
8765
8766 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8767 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8768 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8769
8770 @itemize
8771 @item
8772 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8773 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8774 supports such an interface.
8775 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8776 and trace port support.)
8777 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8778 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8779 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8780 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8781 in the board-specific configuration file.
8782 @item
8783 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8784 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8785 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8786 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8787 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8788 @end itemize
8789
8790 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8791
8792 @quotation Issues
8793 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8794 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8795
8796 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8797 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8798 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8799 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8800 dummy trace port driver}.
8801
8802 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8803 as well as tracing only during specific states
8804 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8805
8806 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8807 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8808 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8809 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8810 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8811
8812 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8813 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8814 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8815 this original style of JTAG access.
8816 @end quotation
8817
8818 @subsection ETM Configuration
8819 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8820
8821 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8822 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8823 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8824
8825 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8826 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8827 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8828 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8829 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8830 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8831 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8832 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8833 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8834
8835 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8836 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8837 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8838
8839 @quotation Warning
8840 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8841 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8842 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8843 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8844 @end quotation
8845
8846 @quotation Note
8847 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8848 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8849 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8850 what CPU activities are traced.
8851 @end quotation
8852 @end deffn
8853
8854 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8855 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8856 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8857 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8858 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8859 @end deffn
8860
8861 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8862 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8863 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8864 Did trace data overflow?
8865 Was it triggered?
8866 @end deffn
8867
8868 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8869 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8870 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8871 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8872 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8873
8874 @itemize
8875 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8876 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8877 The value is one of
8878 @option{none} (save nothing),
8879 @option{data} (save data),
8880 @option{address} (save addresses),
8881 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8882 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8883 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8884 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8885 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8886 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8887 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8888 trace stream without an image of the code.
8889 @end itemize
8890 @end deffn
8891
8892 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8893 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8894 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8895 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8896 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8897
8898 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8899 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8900 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8901 @end deffn
8902
8903 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8904
8905 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8906 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8907 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8908
8909 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8910 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8911 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8912 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8913 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8914 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8915 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8916
8917 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8918
8919 @itemize
8920 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8921 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8922 for instruction access within that function's body.
8923 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8924 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8925 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8926 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8927 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8928 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8929 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8930 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8931 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8932 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8933 @item @emph{... more}
8934 @end itemize
8935
8936 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8937 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8938
8939 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8940 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8941 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8945 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8946 @end deffn
8947
8948 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8949 Opens an image file.
8950 @end deffn
8951
8952 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8953 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8954 @end deffn
8955
8956 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8957 Starts trace data collection.
8958 @end deffn
8959
8960 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8961 Stops trace data collection.
8962 @end deffn
8963
8964 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8965 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8966
8967 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8968
8969 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8970 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8971 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8972 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8973 any trace data collection.}
8974 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8975 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8976 @end deffn
8977 @end deffn
8978
8979 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8980 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8981 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8982 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8983 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8984 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8985 @end deffn
8986 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8987 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8988 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8989 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8990 trace trigger becomes active.
8991
8992 @itemize
8993 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8994 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8995 afterwards.
8996 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8997 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8998 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8999 what caused that event to happen.
9000 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9001 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9002 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9003 how the event caused trouble.
9004 @end itemize
9005 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9006 @end deffn
9007
9008 @end deffn
9009
9010 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9011 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9012 @cindex CTI
9013
9014 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9015 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9016 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9017 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9018 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9019 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9020
9021 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9022 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9023 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9024 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9025 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9026 including additional configuration.
9027 @end deffn
9028
9029 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9030 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9031 @end deffn
9032
9033 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9034 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9035 @end deffn
9036
9037 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9038 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9039 @end deffn
9040
9041 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9042 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9043 @end deffn
9044
9045 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9046 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9047 @end deffn
9048
9049 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9050 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9051 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9052 @end deffn
9053
9054 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9055 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9056 of the CTI.
9057 @end deffn
9058
9059 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9060 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9061 useful in TCL scripting.
9062 @end deffn
9063
9064 @section Generic ARM
9065 @cindex ARM
9066
9067 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9068 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9069 commands that may be available.
9070
9071 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9072 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9073 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9074 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9075 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9076 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9077 @end deffn
9078
9079 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9080 @cindex disassemble
9081 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9082 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9083 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9084 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9085 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9086 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9087 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9088
9089 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9090 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9091 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9092 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9093 with a handful of exceptions.
9094 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9095 @end deffn
9096
9097 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9098 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9099 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9100 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9101 and using the MCR instruction.
9102 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9103 an ARM register.)
9104 @end deffn
9105
9106 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9107 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9108 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9109 and the MRC instruction.
9110 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9111 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9112 an ARM register.)
9113 @end deffn
9114
9115 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9116 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9117 core mode if necessary.
9118 @end deffn
9119
9120 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9121 @cindex ARM semihosting
9122 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9123
9124 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9125 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9126 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9127 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9128 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9129 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9130 @end deffn
9131
9132 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9133 @cindex ARM semihosting
9134 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9135
9136 @example
9137 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9138 @end example
9139
9140 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9141 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9142 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9143 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9144 @end deffn
9145
9146 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9147 @cindex ARM semihosting
9148 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9149 status.
9150
9151 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9152 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9153 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9154 debugger.
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9158 @cindex ARM semihosting
9159 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9160
9161 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9162 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9163 the value returned by the target.
9164
9165 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9166 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9167 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9168 encountering a break.
9169
9170 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9171 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9172 to the debugger.
9173 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9174 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9175 request or equivalent").
9176
9177 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9178 this option (default: disabled).
9179 @end deffn
9180
9181 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9182 @cindex ARMv4
9183 @cindex ARMv5
9184
9185 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9186 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9187 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9188 variant.
9189
9190 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9191 @cindex ARM7
9192 @cindex ARM9
9193
9194 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9195 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9196 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9197 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9198
9199 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9200 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9201 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9202 instead of breakpoints.
9203 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9204
9205 This should be
9206 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9207 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9208 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9212 @cindex DCC
9213 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9214 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9215 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9216
9217 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9218 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9219 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9220 @end deffn
9221
9222 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9223 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9224 that don't check completion of the operation.
9225 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9226
9227 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9228 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9229 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9230 @end deffn
9231
9232 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9233 @cindex ARM9
9234
9235 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9236 integer processors.
9237 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9238
9239 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9240 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9241 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9242 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9243
9244 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9245 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9246 @cindex vector_catch
9247 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9248 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9249 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9250 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9251 to those hardware vectors.
9252
9253 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9254 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9255 vector catch hardware to intercept
9256 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9257 @option{none} of them,
9258 or a list with one or more of the following:
9259 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9260 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9261 @end deffn
9262
9263 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9264 @cindex ARM920T
9265
9266 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9267 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9268 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9269 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9270 and ARM9 commands.
9271
9272 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9273 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9274 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9275 @end deffn
9276
9277 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9278 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9279 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9280 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9281 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9282 (Not all registers can be written.)
9283 @end deffn
9284
9285 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9286 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9287 @end deffn
9288
9289 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9290 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9291 @end deffn
9292
9293 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9294 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9295
9296 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9297 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9298 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9299 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9300 and ARM9 commands.
9301
9302 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9303 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9304
9305 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9306 Print information about the caches found.
9307 @end deffn
9308
9309 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9310 @cindex ARM966E
9311
9312 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9313 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9314 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9315 and ARM9 commands.
9316
9317 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9318 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9319 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9320 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9321 ARM966E-S TRM.
9322 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9323 as required for BIST support.
9324 @end deffn
9325
9326 @subsection XScale specific commands
9327 @cindex XScale
9328
9329 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9330
9331 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9332 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9333 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9334 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9335 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9336 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9337 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9338
9339 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9340 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9341 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9342 the mini-IC.
9343
9344 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9345 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9346 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9347 code layout in memory:
9348 @example
9349 _vectors:
9350 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9351 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9352 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9353 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9354 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9355 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9356 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9357 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9358 .org 0x100
9359 .long real_reset_vector
9360 .long real_ui_handler
9361 .long real_swi_handler
9362 .long real_pf_abort
9363 .long real_data_abort
9364 .long 0 /* unused */
9365 .long real_irq_handler
9366 .long real_fiq_handler
9367 @end example
9368
9369 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9370 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9371 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9372 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9373 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9374 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9375 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9376 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9377 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9378 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9379 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9380 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9381 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9382 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9383 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9384 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9385 software.
9386
9387 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9388 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9389 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9390 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9391
9392 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9393 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9394 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9395 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9396 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9397 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9398 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9399 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9400 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9401
9402 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9403 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9404
9405 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9406 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9407 @end deffn
9408
9409 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9410 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9411 @end deffn
9412
9413 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9414 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9415 @end deffn
9416
9417 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9418 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9419 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9423 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9424 @end deffn
9425
9426 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9427 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9428 @end deffn
9429
9430 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9431 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9435 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9439 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9440 @end deffn
9441
9442 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9443 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9444 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9445 and modifying how it is emptied.
9446 @end deffn
9447
9448 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9449 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9450 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9451 The image @var{type} may be one of
9452 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9453 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9454 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9455 @end deffn
9456
9457 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9458 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9459 @cindex vector_catch
9460 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9461 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9462
9463 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9464 @example
9465 0x01 Trap Reset
9466 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9467 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9468 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9469 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9470 0x20 reserved
9471 0x40 Trap IRQ
9472 0x80 Trap FIQ
9473 @end example
9474 @end deffn
9475
9476 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9477 @cindex vector_table
9478
9479 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9480 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9481 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9482 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9483 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9484
9485 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9486
9487 @end deffn
9488
9489 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9490 @cindex ARMv6
9491
9492 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9493 @cindex ARM11
9494
9495 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9496 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9497 which is enabled by default.
9498 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9499 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9500 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9501 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9502 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9503 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9504 @end deffn
9505
9506 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9507 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9508 which is enabled by default.
9509 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9510 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9511 @end deffn
9512
9513 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9514 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9515 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9516 they are disabled by default.
9517 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9518 @end deffn
9519
9520 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9521 @cindex vector_catch
9522 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9523 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9524 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9525
9526 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9527 for certain hardware events.
9528 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9529 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9530 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9531 @end deffn
9532
9533 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9534 @cindex ARMv7
9535 @cindex ARMv8
9536
9537 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9538 @cindex Cortex-A
9539
9540 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9541 display information about target caches
9542 @end deffn
9543
9544 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9545 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9546 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9547 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9548 Defaults to 'off'.
9549 @end deffn
9550
9551 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9552 Initialize core debug
9553 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9554 @end deffn
9555
9556 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9557 Display/set the current SMP mode
9558 @end deffn
9559
9560 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9561 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9562 @end deffn
9563
9564 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9565 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9566 @end deffn
9567
9568 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9569 configure l2x cache
9570 @end deffn
9571
9572 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9573 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9574 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9575 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9576 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9577 @end deffn
9578
9579 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9580 @cindex Cortex-R
9581
9582 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9583 Initialize core debug
9584 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9585 @end deffn
9586
9587 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9588 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9589 @end deffn
9590
9591
9592 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9593 @cindex tracing
9594 @cindex SWO
9595 @cindex SWV
9596 @cindex TPIU
9597
9598 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9599 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9600 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9601 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9602
9603 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9604 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9605 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9606 which causes quite some confusion.
9607 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9608 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9609
9610 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9611 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9612 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9613
9614 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9615 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9616 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9617 @end deffn
9618
9619 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9620 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9621 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9622 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9623
9624 @itemize @bullet
9625 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9626 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9627 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9628 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9629
9630 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9631 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9632 @end itemize
9633 @end deffn
9634
9635 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9636 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9637 @end deffn
9638
9639 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9640 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9641 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9642 at any time after the initialization, too.
9643 @end deffn
9644
9645 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9646 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9647 individually queried, to return its current value.
9648 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9649 @end deffn
9650
9651 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9652 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9653 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9654 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9655
9656 @itemize @bullet
9657 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9658 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9659
9660 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9661 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9662
9663 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9664 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9665
9666 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9667 protocol used for trace data:
9668 @itemize @minus
9669 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9670 data bits (default);
9671 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9672 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9673 @end itemize
9674
9675 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9676 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9677 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9678 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9679 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9680 of the TPIU.
9681
9682 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9683 the destination of the trace data:
9684 @itemize @minus
9685 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9686 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9687 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9688 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9689 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9690 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9691 each connected client;
9692 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9693 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9694 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9695 @end itemize
9696
9697 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9698 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9699 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9700 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9701
9702 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9703 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9704 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9705 maximum supported rate automatically.
9706
9707 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9708 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9709 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9710
9711 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9712 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9713 default value is @var{0}.
9714 @end itemize
9715 @end deffn
9716
9717 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9718 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9719 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9720 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9721 data.
9722 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9723 after the @command{init}.
9724 @end deffn
9725
9726 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9727 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9728 @end deffn
9729
9730
9731
9732 Example usage:
9733 @enumerate
9734 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9735 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9736 enough to:
9737 @example
9738 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9739 ...
9740 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9741 ...
9742 @end example
9743 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9744 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9745 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9746 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9747 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9748 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9749 @example
9750 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9751 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9752 @end example
9753 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9754 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9755 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9756 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9757 @example
9758 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9759 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9760 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9761 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9762 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9763 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9764 @end example
9765 @end enumerate
9766
9767 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9768 @cindex tracing
9769 @cindex SWO
9770 @cindex SWV
9771 @cindex ITM
9772 @cindex ETM
9773
9774 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9775 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9776 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9777 @end deffn
9778
9779 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9780 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9781 @end deffn
9782
9783 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9784 @cindex Cortex-M
9785
9786 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9787 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9788
9789 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9790 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9791 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9792 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9793 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9794 the step command leaves with the core running.
9795
9796 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9797 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9798 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9799 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9800
9801 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9802 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9803 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9804 does.
9805
9806 Default is @option{auto}.
9807 @end deffn
9808
9809 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9810 @cindex vector_catch
9811 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9812 for certain hardware events.
9813
9814 Parameters request interception of
9815 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9816 @option{none} of them,
9817 or one or more of the following:
9818 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9819 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9820 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9821 @option{irq_err},
9822 @option{state_err},
9823 @option{chk_err}, or
9824 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9825 @option{reset}.
9826 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9827 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9828 are mapped to HardFault.
9829 UsageFault checks for
9830 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9831 must also be explicitly enabled.
9832
9833 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9834 @end deffn
9835
9836 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9837 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9838 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9839
9840 @itemize @minus
9841 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9842 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9843 @end itemize
9844
9845 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9846 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9847 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9848 to manually reset the peripherals.
9849 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9850
9851 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9852 instead.
9853 @end deffn
9854
9855 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9856 @cindex ARMv8-A
9857 @cindex aarch64
9858
9859 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9860 Display information about target caches
9861 @end deffn
9862
9863 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9864 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9865 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9866 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9867 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9868 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9869 @end deffn
9870
9871 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9872 @cindex disassemble
9873 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9874 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9875 @end deffn
9876
9877 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9878 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9879 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9880 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9881 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9882 @end deffn
9883
9884 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9885 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9886 @option{on}.
9887 @end deffn
9888
9889 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9890 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9891 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9892 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9893 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9894 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9895 @end deffn
9896
9897 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9898
9899 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9900 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9901
9902 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9903
9904 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9905 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9906 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9907 @end deffn
9908
9909 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9910 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9911 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9912 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9913 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9914 @end deffn
9915
9916 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9917
9918 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9919 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9920 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9921 @end deffn
9922
9923 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9924
9925 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9926 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9927 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9928 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9929 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9930 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9931 can be collected.
9932
9933 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9934 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9935 tooling.
9936
9937 @quotation Issues
9938 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9939 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9940 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9941 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9942
9943 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9944 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9945 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9946 software operation on the CPU.
9947 @end quotation
9948
9949 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9950 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9951 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9952 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9953 @end deffn
9954
9955 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9956 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9957 @end deffn
9958
9959 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9960 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9961 control is disabled.
9962 @end deffn
9963
9964 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9965 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9966 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9967 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9968
9969 Supported trace formats:
9970 @itemize
9971 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9972 timing to be determined.
9973 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9974 addresses.
9975 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9976 @end itemize
9977 @end deffn
9978
9979 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9980 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9981 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9982 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9983
9984 Supported conditions:
9985 @itemize
9986 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9987 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9988 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9989 instruction matches start data and mask.
9990 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9991 instruction matches start data and mask.
9992 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9993 data and mask.
9994 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9995 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9996 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9997 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9998 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9999 @end itemize
10000 @end deffn
10001
10002 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10003 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10004 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10005 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10006
10007 Supported conditions:
10008 @itemize
10009 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10010 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10011 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10012 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10013 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10014 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10015 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10016 data and mask.
10017 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10018 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10019 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10020 @end itemize
10021 @end deffn
10022
10023 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10024 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10025
10026 Supported triggers:
10027 @itemize
10028 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10029 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10030 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10031 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10032 collection.
10033 @end itemize
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10037
10038 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10039 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10040 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10041 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10042 @end deffn
10043
10044 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10045 Display trace configuration.
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10049 Display trace collection status.
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10053 Start manual trace collection.
10054 @end deffn
10055
10056 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10057 Stop manual trace collection.
10058 @end deffn
10059
10060 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10061 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10062 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10063 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10064 @option{size} options using DMA.
10065 @end deffn
10066
10067 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10068 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10069 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10070 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10071 @option{size} options using DMA.
10072 @end deffn
10073
10074 @section Intel Architecture
10075
10076 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10077 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10078 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10079 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10080 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10081 @itemize
10082 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10083 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10084 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10085 @end itemize
10086
10087 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10088 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10089 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10090
10091 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10092 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10093 @end deffn
10094
10095 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10096 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10097 @end deffn
10098
10099 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10100 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10101 @end deffn
10102
10103 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10104 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10105 @end deffn
10106
10107 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10108 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10109 @end deffn
10110
10111 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10112 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10113 @end deffn
10114
10115 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10116
10117 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10118 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10119
10120 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10121 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10122 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10123 @end deffn
10124 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10125 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10126
10127 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10128
10129 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10130 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10131 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10132 @end deffn
10133
10134 @subsection Registers commands
10135 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10136 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10137 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10138
10139 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10140
10141 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10142 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10143 and "timer" groups.
10144
10145 @emph{example:}
10146 @example
10147 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10148 @end example
10149
10150 @end deffn
10151
10152 @section RISC-V Architecture
10153
10154 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10155 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10156 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10157 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10158 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10159 implement version 0.11.
10160
10161 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10162
10163 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10164 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10165 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10166
10167 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10168
10169 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10170 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10171 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10172
10173 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10174 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10175 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10176 CSRs.
10177 @end deffn
10178
10179 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10180 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10181 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10182 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10183 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10184 This command must be executed before `init`.
10185 @end deffn
10186
10187 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10188 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10189 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10190 @end deffn
10191
10192 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10193 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10194 deasserted.
10195 @end deffn
10196
10197 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10198 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10199 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10200 @end deffn
10201
10202 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10203 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10204 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10205 on physical memory.
10206 @end deffn
10207
10208 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10209 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10210 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10211 performed on physical memory.
10212 @end deffn
10213
10214 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10215 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10216 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10217 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10218 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10219 race condition problem in your code.
10220
10221 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10222 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10223 @end deffn
10224
10225 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10226 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10227 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10228 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10229 values.
10230
10231 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10232 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10233 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10234 @end deffn
10235
10236 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10237 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10238 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10239 @end deffn
10240
10241 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10242 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10243 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10247 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10248 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10252 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10253 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10254 @end deffn
10255
10256 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10257
10258 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10259 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10260 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10261 @example
10262 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10263 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10264 @end example
10265
10266 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10267 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10268 @end deffn
10269
10270 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10271 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10272 @end deffn
10273
10274 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10275
10276 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10277 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10278
10279 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10280 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10281 @end deffn
10282
10283 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10284 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10285 @end deffn
10286
10287 @section ARC Architecture
10288 @cindex ARC
10289
10290 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10291 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10292 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10293 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10294 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10295 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10296 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10297 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10298 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10299 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10300 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10301 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10302 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10303 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10304 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10305
10306
10307 @subsection General ARC commands
10308
10309 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10310
10311 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10312 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10313 arguments:
10314
10315 @itemize @bullet
10316
10317 @item @code{-name} name
10318 @*Name of a register.
10319
10320 @item @code{-num} number
10321 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10322
10323 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10324 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10325
10326 @end itemize
10327
10328 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10329
10330 @itemize @bullet
10331
10332 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10333 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10334 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10335 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10336 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10337 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10338
10339 @item @code{-core}
10340 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10341 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10342 spaces.
10343
10344 @item @code{-bcr}
10345 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10346 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10347 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10348 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10349 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10350
10351 @item @code{-type} type_name
10352 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10353 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10354
10355 @item @code{-g}
10356 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10357 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10358 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10359 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10360 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10361
10362 @end itemize
10363
10364 @end deffn
10365
10366 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10367 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10368 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10369 @end deffn
10370
10371 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10372 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10373 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10374 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10375 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10376 startbit endbit}.
10377 @end deffn
10378
10379 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10380 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10381 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10382 @end deffn
10383
10384 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10385 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10386 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10387 @end deffn
10388
10389 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10390
10391 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10392 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10393 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10394 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10395
10396 @end deffn
10397
10398 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10399 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10400 registers.
10401 @end deffn
10402
10403 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10404 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10405 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10406 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10407
10408 @end deffn
10409
10410 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10411 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10412 registers.
10413 @end deffn
10414
10415 @section STM8 Architecture
10416 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10417 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10418
10419 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10420 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10421
10422 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10423 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10424 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10425 @cindex tracing
10426 @cindex libdcc
10427 @cindex DCC
10428 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10429 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10430 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10431 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10432
10433 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10434 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10435 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10436 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10437 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10438 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10439
10440 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10441 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10442 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10443 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10444 The target being debugged may
10445 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10446 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10447 each supported by a command:
10448
10449 @itemize
10450 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10451 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10452 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10453 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10454
10455 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10456 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10457 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10458
10459 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10460 and then displayed at any time.
10461 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10462
10463 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10464 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10465 @end itemize
10466
10467 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10468 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10469 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10470 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10471 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10472 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10473 does the same thing.
10474
10475 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10476 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10477 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10478 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10479 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10480
10481 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10482 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10483 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10484 @end deffn
10485
10486 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10487 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10488 in the order they triggered.
10489 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10490 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10491 history records.
10492 @end deffn
10493
10494 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10495 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10496 they have been triggered.
10497 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10498 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10499 and associates it with that identifier.
10500
10501 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10502 are not related except by this command.
10503 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10504 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10505 @end deffn
10506
10507
10508 @node JTAG Commands
10509 @chapter JTAG Commands
10510 @cindex JTAG Commands
10511 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10512 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10513 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10514 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10515 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10516
10517 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10518 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10519
10520 @itemize @bullet
10521 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10522 devices such as a CPUs.
10523 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10524 standard state machine (in parallel)
10525 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10526 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10527 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10528 while the reading previous ones.
10529 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10530 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10531 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10532 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10533 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10534 registers.
10535 @end itemize
10536
10537 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10538
10539 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10540 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10541 the order of TAP state transitions.
10542 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10543 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10544 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10545 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10546 these commands are not available.
10547
10548 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10549 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10550 that specify the entire register.
10551 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10552 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10553 The return value holds the original value of each
10554 of those fields.
10555
10556 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10557 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10558 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10559 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10560 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10561
10562 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10563 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10564
10565 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10566 in that state.
10567 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10568 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10569 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10570
10571 @quotation Warning
10572 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10573 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10574 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10575 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10576 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10577 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10578 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10579 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10580 @end quotation
10581 @end deffn
10582
10583 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10584 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10585 This may be used for performance tuning.
10586
10587 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10588 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10589 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10590 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10591 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10592 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10593 @end deffn
10594
10595 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10596 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10597 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10598 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10599 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10600 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10601
10602 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10603 in that state.
10604 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10605 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10606 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10607
10608 @quotation Note
10609 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10610 register values, unlike data register values.
10611 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10612 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10613 @end quotation
10614 @end deffn
10615
10616 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10617 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10618 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10619 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10620 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10621 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10622 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10623 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10624 The final state must also be stable.
10625 @end deffn
10626
10627 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10628 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10629 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10630 Instructions often need some time
10631 to execute before they take effect.
10632 @end deffn
10633
10634 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10635 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10636
10637 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10638 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10639 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10640 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10641 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10642 @end deffn
10643
10644 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10645 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10646 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10647 must also be enabled.
10648 Default is enabled.
10649 @end deffn
10650
10651 @section TAP state names
10652 @cindex TAP state names
10653
10654 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10655 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10656 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10657 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10658
10659 @itemize @bullet
10660 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10661 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10662 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10663 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10664 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10665 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10666 through the data register
10667 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10668 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10669 for update or more shifting
10670 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10671 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10672 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10673 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10674 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10675 through the instruction register
10676 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10677 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10678 for update or more shifting
10679 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10680 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10681 @end itemize
10682
10683 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10684 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10685 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10686 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10687
10688 @itemize @bullet
10689 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10690 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10691 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10692 may not be as expected.
10693 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10694 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10695 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10696 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10697 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10698 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10699 @end itemize
10700
10701 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10702 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10703
10704 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10705 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10706 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10707 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10708
10709 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10710 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10711 @cindex SVF
10712
10713 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10714 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10715 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10716 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10717
10718 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10719 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10720 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10721 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10722
10723 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10724 affect their semantics.
10725
10726 Command options:
10727 @itemize @minus
10728 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10729 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10730 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10731 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10732 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10733 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10734 on the real interface;
10735 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10736 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10737 errors.
10738 @end itemize
10739 @end deffn
10740
10741 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10742 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10743 @cindex XSVF
10744
10745 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10746 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10747 Xilinx devices.
10748 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10749 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10750
10751 @quotation Important
10752 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10753 @end quotation
10754
10755 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10756 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10757 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10758 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10759 that TAP.
10760 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10761 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10762 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10763 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10764 @end deffn
10765
10766 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10767 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10768 after building the software.
10769 You may find them useful:
10770
10771 @itemize
10772 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10773 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10774 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10775 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10776 @end itemize
10777
10778 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10779 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10780 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10781 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10782 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10783 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10784 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10785
10786
10787 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10788 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10789 @cindex IPDBG
10790
10791 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10792 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10793 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10794 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10795 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10796 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10797
10798 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10799 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10800
10801 Command options:
10802 @itemize @bullet
10803 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10804 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10805 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10806 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10807 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10808 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10809 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10810 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10811 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10812 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10813 shift data through vir can be configured.
10814 @end itemize
10815 @end deffn
10816
10817 Examples:
10818 @example
10819 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10820 @end example
10821 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10822 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10823
10824 @example
10825 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10826 @end example
10827 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10828 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10829
10830 @node Utility Commands
10831 @chapter Utility Commands
10832 @cindex Utility Commands
10833
10834 @section RAM testing
10835 @cindex RAM testing
10836
10837 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10838 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10839 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10840 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10841 hardware problems.
10842
10843 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10844 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10845 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10846 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10847
10848 Load the memory testing functions with
10849
10850 @example
10851 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10852 @end example
10853
10854 to get access to the following facilities:
10855
10856 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10857 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10858 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10859 @end deffn
10860
10861 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10862 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10863 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10864 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10865 @end deffn
10866
10867 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10868 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10869 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10870 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10871 @end deffn
10872
10873 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10874 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10875 @end deffn
10876
10877 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10878 @cindex Firmware recovery
10879
10880 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10881 devices recovery with JTAG.
10882
10883 For quickstart instructions run:
10884 @example
10885 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10886 @end example
10887
10888 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10889 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10890 @cindex GDB
10891 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10892 to debug remote targets.
10893 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10894
10895 @itemize
10896 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10897 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10898 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10899 as shown in this chapter.
10900 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10901 that also will probably need to be configured.
10902 @end itemize
10903
10904 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10905 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10906 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10907 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10908 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10909 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10910
10911 @section Connecting to GDB
10912 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10913 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10914 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10915 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10916 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10917
10918 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10919
10920 @enumerate
10921 @item
10922 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10923 @example
10924 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10925 @end example
10926 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10927
10928 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10929 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10930 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10931
10932 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10933 remote command above that becomes:
10934 @example
10935 tar ext :3333
10936 @end example
10937
10938 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10939 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10940 available through the command:
10941 @example
10942 target remote localhost:3333
10943 @end example
10944
10945 @item
10946 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10947 @example
10948 target extended-remote | \
10949 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10950 @end example
10951 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10952 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10953 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10954 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10955 @end enumerate
10956
10957 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10958 GDB command line.
10959
10960 @section Sample GDB session startup
10961
10962 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10963 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10964 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10965 small ARM program.
10966 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10967 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10968
10969 @example
10970 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10971 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10972 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10973 ...
10974 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10975 ...
10976 (gdb) load
10977 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10978 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10979 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10980 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10981 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10982 (gdb) continue
10983 Continuing.
10984 ...
10985 @end example
10986
10987 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10988 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10989 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10990 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10991
10992 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10993
10994 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10995 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10996 packet size and the device's memory map.
10997 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10998 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10999 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11000
11001 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11002 You may need to set those up by hand.
11003 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11004 something like:
11005
11006 @example
11007 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11008 @end example
11009
11010 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11011
11012 @example
11013 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11014 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11015 @end example
11016
11017 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11018 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11019 do not have such restrictions.
11020
11021 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11022 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11023 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11024 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11025
11026 @section Programming using GDB
11027 @cindex Programming using GDB
11028 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11029
11030 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11031 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11032 @example
11033 gdb_memory_map disable
11034 @end example
11035 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11036 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11037 working area.
11038
11039 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11040 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11041 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11042 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11043
11044 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11045 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11046
11047 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11048 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11049 @example
11050 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11051 @end example
11052
11053 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11054 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11055
11056 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11057 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11058 will be used.
11059
11060 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11061 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11062 @example
11063 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11064 @end example
11065 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11066
11067 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11068 can be used.
11069
11070 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11071 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11072 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11073
11074 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11075 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11076 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11077
11078 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11079 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11080 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11081 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11082 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11083 without any intrusion of the target process.
11084
11085 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11086 Place following command after target configuration:
11087 @example
11088 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11089 @end example
11090
11091 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11092 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11093 @example
11094 gdb_memory_map disable
11095 @end example
11096
11097 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11098 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11099 @example
11100 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11101 @end example
11102
11103 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11104 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11105
11106 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11107 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11108 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11109 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11110
11111 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11112 previously shown variables.
11113
11114 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11115 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11116 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11117 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11118 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11119
11120 @section RTOS Support
11121 @cindex RTOS Support
11122 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11123
11124 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11125 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11126
11127 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11128 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11129 GDB commands.
11130
11131 @* An example setup is below:
11132
11133 @example
11134 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11135 @end example
11136
11137 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11138
11139 Currently supported rtos's include:
11140 @itemize @bullet
11141 @item @option{eCos}
11142 @item @option{ThreadX}
11143 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11144 @item @option{linux}
11145 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11146 @item @option{embKernel}
11147 @item @option{mqx}
11148 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11149 @item @option{nuttx}
11150 @item @option{RIOT}
11151 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11152 @item @option{Zephyr}
11153 @end itemize
11154
11155 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11156 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11157
11158 @table @code
11159 @item eCos symbols
11160 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11161 @item ThreadX symbols
11162 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11163 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11164 @raggedright
11165 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11166 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11167 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11168 @end raggedright
11169 @item linux symbols
11170 init_task.
11171 @item ChibiOS symbols
11172 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11173 @item embKernel symbols
11174 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11175 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11176 @item mqx symbols
11177 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11178 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11179 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11180 @item nuttx symbols
11181 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11182 @item RIOT symbols
11183 @raggedright
11184 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11185 _tcb_name_offset.
11186 @end raggedright
11187 @item Zephyr symbols
11188 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11189 @end table
11190
11191 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11192 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11193
11194 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11195 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11196
11197 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11198 along with the project:
11199
11200 @table @code
11201 @item FreeRTOS
11202 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11203 @item uC/OS-III
11204 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11205 @end table
11206
11207 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11208 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11209 @cindex SMP
11210 @cindex RTOS
11211 @cindex hwthread
11212 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11213 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11214 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11215 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11216 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11217 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11218 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11219 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11220 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11221
11222 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11223 @quotation Note
11224 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11225 @end quotation
11226
11227 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11228 @itemize @bullet
11229 @item j - smp status request
11230 @item J - smp set request
11231 @end itemize
11232
11233 OpenOCD implements :
11234 @itemize @bullet
11235 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11236 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11237 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11238 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11239 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11240 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11241 @end itemize
11242
11243 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11244 @itemize @bullet
11245 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11246 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11247 @example
11248 set $_core 1
11249 #Jc01 packet is sent
11250 print $_core
11251 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11252 @end example
11253
11254 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11255 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11256
11257 @example
11258 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11259 define toggle0
11260 maint packet Jc0
11261 continue
11262 main packet Jc-1
11263 end
11264 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11265 define toggle1
11266 maint packet Jc1
11267 continue
11268 main packet Jc-1
11269 end
11270 @end example
11271 @end itemize
11272
11273 @node Tcl Scripting API
11274 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11275 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11276 @cindex Tcl scripts
11277 @section API rules
11278
11279 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11280 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11281 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11282
11283 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11284 pair list and lists.
11285
11286 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11287 list.
11288
11289 @example
11290 > set foo(me) Duane
11291 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11292 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11293 > set foo(duck) Donald
11294 @end example
11295
11296 If one does this:
11297
11298 @example
11299 > set foo
11300 @end example
11301
11302 The result is:
11303
11304 @example
11305 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11306 @end example
11307
11308 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11309
11310 @verbatim
11311 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11312 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11313 }
11314 @end verbatim
11315
11316 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11317 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11318
11319 @section Internal low-level Commands
11320
11321 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11322 invoke directly.
11323
11324 @itemize @bullet
11325 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11326
11327 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11328 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11329
11330 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11331 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11332
11333 Return information about the flash banks
11334
11335 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11336
11337 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11338 its execution. Example:
11339
11340 @example
11341 > capture "reset init"
11342 @end example
11343
11344 @end itemize
11345
11346 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11347 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11348 called "flash_banks".
11349
11350 @section Tcl RPC server
11351 @cindex RPC
11352
11353 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11354 commands and receive the results.
11355
11356 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11357 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11358 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11359 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11360 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11361
11362 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11363 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11364 @command{capture} command.
11365
11366 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11367
11368 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11369 @cindex RPC Notifications
11370
11371 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11372 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11373
11374 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11375 in the following format.
11376
11377 @verbatim
11378 type target_event event [event-name]
11379 type target_state state [state-name]
11380 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11381 @end verbatim
11382
11383 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11384 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11385 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11386 Defaults to off.
11387
11388 @end deffn
11389
11390 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11391 @cindex RPC trace output
11392
11393 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11394 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11395
11396 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11397
11398 @verbatim
11399 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11400 @end verbatim
11401
11402 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11403 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11404 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11405 Defaults to off.
11406
11407 See an example application here:
11408 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11409
11410 @end deffn
11411
11412 @node FAQ
11413 @chapter FAQ
11414 @cindex faq
11415 @enumerate
11416 @anchor{faqrtck}
11417 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11418 @cindex RTCK
11419 @cindex adaptive clocking
11420 @*
11421
11422 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11423 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11424 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11425 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11426
11427 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11428 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11429 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11430 @enumerate
11431 @item
11432 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11433 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11434 @item
11435 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11436 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11437 @end enumerate
11438
11439 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11440 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11441 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11442 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11443 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11444 power).
11445
11446 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11447 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11448 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11449 ARM926 scenario).
11450 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11451 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11452 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11453
11454 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11455 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11456 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11457 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11458
11459 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11460
11461 In order to make use of this,
11462 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11463 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11464
11465 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11466 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11467 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11468 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11469 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11470
11471 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11472 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11473 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11474 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11475
11476 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11477 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11478 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11479 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11480 with a CPLD.
11481 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11482 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11483 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11484 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11485 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11486 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11487
11488 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11489
11490 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11491
11492 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11493 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11494 depending on the chips on your board.
11495 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11496 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11497 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11498
11499 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11500 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11501 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11502
11503 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11504 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11505 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11506 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11507
11508 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11509 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11510 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11511 this way.
11512
11513 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11514 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11515 clock rate.
11516 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11517 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11518 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11519
11520 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11521
11522 @example
11523 # Example: 1.234MHz
11524 adapter speed 1234
11525 @end example
11526
11527
11528 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11529
11530 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11531 around Windows filenames.
11532
11533 @example
11534 > echo \a
11535
11536 > echo @{\a@}
11537 \a
11538 > echo "\a"
11539
11540 >
11541 @end example
11542
11543
11544 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11545
11546 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11547 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11548 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11549
11550 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11551 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11552 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11553
11554 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11555 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11556 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11557
11558 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11559
11560 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11561 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11562 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11563 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11564
11565 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11566 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11567 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11568
11569 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11570 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11571
11572 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11573 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11574 memory read caused data abort".
11575
11576 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11577 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11578 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11579 be done, feel free to add this here.
11580
11581 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11582 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11583 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11584 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11585 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11586 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11587 gracefully stops.
11588
11589 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11590 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11591 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11592
11593 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11594 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11595 bytes. Painful...
11596
11597
11598 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11599 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11600
11601 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11602 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11603 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11604 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11605 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11606 reset, everything else should work fine.
11607
11608 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11609 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11610 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11611 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11612
11613 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11614 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11615 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11616 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11617
11618 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11619
11620 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11621 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11622 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11623
11624 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11625 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11626
11627 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11628 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11629 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11630 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11631 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11632 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11633 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11634 clock frequency?
11635
11636 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11637 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11638 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11639 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11640 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11641
11642 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11643
11644 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11645 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11646 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11647 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11648 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11649 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11650 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11651
11652 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11653
11654 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11655 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11656 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11657 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11658
11659 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11660 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11661 particular order?
11662
11663 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11664 the same order used by the hardware.
11665
11666 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11667 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11668 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11669 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11670 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11671 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11672
11673 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11674 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11675 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11676 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11677
11678 @itemize @bullet
11679 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11680 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11681 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11682 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11683 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11684 @end itemize
11685
11686 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11687
11688 @itemize @bullet
11689 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11690 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11691 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11692 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11693 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11694 @end itemize
11695
11696
11697 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11698 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11699 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11700
11701 TODO.
11702
11703 @end enumerate
11704
11705 @node Tcl Crash Course
11706 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11707 @cindex Tcl
11708
11709 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11710 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11711 how the Tcl scripts work.
11712
11713 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11714 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11715 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11716 OpenOCD.
11717
11718 @section Tcl Rule #1
11719 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11720 @enumerate
11721 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11722 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11723 @end enumerate
11724
11725 The Tcl equal is this:
11726
11727 @enumerate
11728 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11729 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11730 @end enumerate
11731
11732 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11733 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11734
11735 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11736 There is a second pair of rules.
11737 @enumerate
11738 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11739 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11740 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11741 in Tcl.
11742 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11743 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11744 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11745 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11746 @end enumerate
11747
11748 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11749 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11750 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11751 Everything is a string}
11752
11753 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11754 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11755 difference is subtle.
11756 @enumerate
11757 @item Parse Time
11758 @item Evaluation Time
11759 @end enumerate
11760
11761 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11762 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11763 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11764
11765 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11766 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11767 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11768 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11769
11770 @itemize @bullet
11771 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11772 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11773 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11774 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11775 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11776 @example
11777 # bash example
11778 X=`date`
11779 echo "The Date is: $X"
11780 # Tcl example
11781 set X [date]
11782 puts "The Date is: $X"
11783 @end example
11784 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11785 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11786 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11787 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11788 is a string}
11789 @example
11790 set x "Dinner"
11791 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11792 @end example
11793 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11794 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11795 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11796 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11797 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11798 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11799 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11800 @end itemize
11801
11802 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11803
11804 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11805
11806 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11807
11808 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11809 the normal way.
11810
11811 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11812 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11813 line is immediately executed.
11814
11815 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11816 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11817
11818 @subsection Command Execution
11819
11820 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11821 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11822 control flow operators.
11823
11824 Commands are executed like this:
11825
11826 @enumerate
11827 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11828 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11829 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11830 @end enumerate
11831
11832 It sort of works like this:
11833 @example
11834 for(;;)@{
11835 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11836
11837 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11838
11839 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11840 @}
11841 @end example
11842
11843 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11844 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11845 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11846 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11847 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11848 ``LookupCommand()''
11849
11850 @subsection The FOR command
11851
11852 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11853 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11854 command just like any other command.
11855
11856 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11857 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11858 are:
11859
11860 @enumerate 0
11861 @item The ascii text 'for'
11862 @item The start text
11863 @item The test expression
11864 @item The next text
11865 @item The body text
11866 @end enumerate
11867
11868 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11869 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11870 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11871 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11872
11873 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11874 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11875
11876 @example
11877 int
11878 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11879 int *argc,
11880 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11881 @end example
11882
11883 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11884 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11885 still operates in the same basic way.
11886
11887 @subsection FOR command implementation
11888
11889 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11890 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11891
11892 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11893
11894 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11895
11896 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11897 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11898 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11899
11900 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11901 expression and returns a value.
11902
11903 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11904 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11905 @example
11906 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11907
11908 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11909
11910 int
11911 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11912 int argc,
11913 char **argv )
11914 @{
11915 if( argc != 5 )@{
11916 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11917 return ERROR;
11918 @}
11919
11920 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11921
11922 // Execute the start statement.
11923 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11924
11925 // Top of loop test
11926 for(;;)@{
11927 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11928 if( i == 0 )
11929 break;
11930
11931 // Execute the body
11932 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11933
11934 // Execute the LOOP part
11935 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11936 @}
11937
11938 // Return no error
11939 SetResult( interp, "" );
11940 return SUCCESS;
11941 @}
11942 @end example
11943
11944 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11945 in the same basic way.
11946
11947 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11948
11949 @subsection source and find commands
11950 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11951 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11952 @*Remember the parsing rules
11953 @enumerate
11954 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11955 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11956 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11957 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11958 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11959 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11960 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11961 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11962 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11963 @end enumerate
11964 @subsection format command
11965 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11966 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11967 @b{sprintf()}.
11968 @b{Example}
11969 @example
11970 set x 6
11971 set y 7
11972 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11973 @end example
11974 @enumerate
11975 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11976 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11977 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11978 @* Refer to Rule #1
11979 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11980 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11981 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11982 @end enumerate
11983 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11984 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11985 @example
11986 #1 Good
11987 proc someproc @{@} @{
11988 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11989 @}
11990 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11991 #2 Good - no variables
11992 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11993 #3 Good Curly Braces
11994 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11995 puts "Time: [date]"
11996 @}
11997 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11998 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11999 @end example
12000 @enumerate
12001 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12002 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12003 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12004 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12005 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12006 command.
12007 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12008 @*There are 4 examples:
12009 @enumerate
12010 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12011 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12012 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12013 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12014 @end enumerate
12015
12016 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12017 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12018 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12019
12020 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12021 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12022 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12023 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12024 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12025 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12026 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12027 @end enumerate
12028 @subsection Global Variables
12029 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12030 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12031 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12032 @example
12033 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12034 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12035 global x #Global variable X
12036 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12037 @}
12038 @end example
12039 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12040 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12041 @example
12042 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12043 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12044 # Create var name
12045 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12046 # Make it a global
12047 global $vn
12048 # Set it.
12049 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12050 @}
12051 @end example
12052 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12053 @example
12054 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12055 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12056 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12057 @}
12058 @end example
12059
12060 @node License
12061 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12062 @include fdl.texi
12063
12064 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12065 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12066 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12067 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12068 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12069 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12070
12071 @printindex cp
12072
12073 @node Command and Driver Index
12074 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12075 @printindex fn
12076
12077 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)